[go: up one dir, main page]

WO2007146448A1 - Pharmaceutical formulations of glp-1 derivatives - Google Patents

Pharmaceutical formulations of glp-1 derivatives Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2007146448A1
WO2007146448A1 PCT/US2007/060517 US2007060517W WO2007146448A1 WO 2007146448 A1 WO2007146448 A1 WO 2007146448A1 US 2007060517 W US2007060517 W US 2007060517W WO 2007146448 A1 WO2007146448 A1 WO 2007146448A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
liraglutide
formulation
cyclodextrin
edta
dosage form
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/US2007/060517
Other languages
French (fr)
Inventor
Mary S. Kleppe
Ching-Yuan Li
Michael V. Templin
Original Assignee
Nastech Pharmaceutical Company Inc.
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Nastech Pharmaceutical Company Inc. filed Critical Nastech Pharmaceutical Company Inc.
Publication of WO2007146448A1 publication Critical patent/WO2007146448A1/en

Links

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K38/00Medicinal preparations containing peptides
    • A61K38/16Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof
    • A61K38/17Peptides having more than 20 amino acids; Gastrins; Somatostatins; Melanotropins; Derivatives thereof from animals; from humans
    • A61K38/22Hormones
    • A61K38/26Glucagons
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/30Macromolecular organic or inorganic compounds, e.g. inorganic polyphosphates
    • A61K47/36Polysaccharides; Derivatives thereof, e.g. gums, starch, alginate, dextrin, hyaluronic acid, chitosan, inulin, agar or pectin
    • A61K47/40Cyclodextrins; Derivatives thereof
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K9/00Medicinal preparations characterised by special physical form
    • A61K9/0012Galenical forms characterised by the site of application
    • A61K9/0043Nose
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K9/00Medicinal preparations characterised by special physical form
    • A61K9/08Solutions
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • A61P3/08Drugs for disorders of the metabolism for glucose homeostasis
    • A61P3/10Drugs for disorders of the metabolism for glucose homeostasis for hyperglycaemia, e.g. antidiabetics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/06Organic compounds, e.g. natural or synthetic hydrocarbons, polyolefins, mineral oil, petrolatum or ozokerite
    • A61K47/16Organic compounds, e.g. natural or synthetic hydrocarbons, polyolefins, mineral oil, petrolatum or ozokerite containing nitrogen, e.g. nitro-, nitroso-, azo-compounds, nitriles, cyanates
    • A61K47/18Amines; Amides; Ureas; Quaternary ammonium compounds; Amino acids; Oligopeptides having up to five amino acids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/06Organic compounds, e.g. natural or synthetic hydrocarbons, polyolefins, mineral oil, petrolatum or ozokerite
    • A61K47/24Organic compounds, e.g. natural or synthetic hydrocarbons, polyolefins, mineral oil, petrolatum or ozokerite containing atoms other than carbon, hydrogen, oxygen, halogen, nitrogen or sulfur, e.g. cyclomethicone or phospholipids

Definitions

  • Glucose-regulating peptides are a class of peptides that have therapeutic potential in the treatment of insulin dependent diabetes mellitus (IDDM), gestational diabetes or non insulin-dependent diabetes mellitus (NIDDM), the treatment of obesity and the treatment of dyslipidemia. See U.S. Patent No. 6,506,724; U.S. Patent Application Publication
  • GRPs include glucagons-like peptide (GLP), e.g., GLP-I, GLP-I derivatives, the exendins, especially exendin-4, also known as exenatide, and amylin peptides and amylin analogs such as pramlintide.
  • GLP glucagons-like peptide
  • exendins especially exendin-4, also known as exenatide
  • amylin peptides and amylin analogs such as pramlintide.
  • a major disadvantage of drug administration by injection is that trained personnel are often required to administer the drug. Additionally, trained personnel are put in harms way when administering a drug by injection. For self-administered drugs, many patients are reluctant or unable to give themselves injections on a regular basis. Injection is also associated with increased risks of infection. Other disadvantages of drug injection include variability of delivery results between individuals, as well as unpredictable intensity and duration of drug action.
  • Oral administration is available as an alternative; however, certain therapeutic agents exhibit very low bioavailability and considerable time delay in action when given by this route due to hepatic first-pass metabolism and degradation in the gastrointestinal tract. Thus, there is a need to develop modes of administration for GLPs other than by injection and/or oral administration.
  • Mucosal administration of therapeutic compounds offers certain advantages over injection and other modes of administration, for example convenience and speed of delivery, as well as reducing or eliminating compliance problems and side effects that attend delivery.
  • mucosal delivery of biologically active agents is limited by mucosal barrier functions and other factors.
  • Epithelial cells make up the mucosal barrier and provide a crucial interface between the external environment and mucosal and submucosal tissues and extracellular compartments.
  • One of the most important functions of mucosal epithelial cells is to determine and regulate mucosal permeability.
  • epithelial cells create selective permeability barriers between different physiological compartments. Selective permeability is the result of regulated transport of molecules through the cytoplasm (the transcellular pathway) and the regulated permeability of the spaces between the cells (the paracellular pathway).
  • Tight junctions (TJ) of epithelial and endothelial cells are particularly important for cell-cell junctions that regulate permeability of the paracellular pathway, and also divide the cell surface into apical and basolateral compartments. Tight junctions form continuous circumferential intercellular contacts between epithelial cells and create a regulated barrier to the paracellular movement of water, solutes, and immune cells. They also provide a second type of barrier that contributes to cell polarity by limiting exchange of membrane lipids between the apical and basolateral membrane domains.
  • cell permeation enhancing agents are required to aid their passage across these mucosal surfaces and into systemic circulation where they may quickly act on the target tissue.
  • liraglutide (NN2211), a potent, long-acting, once-daily GLP-I analog, is about 12 hours via subcutaneous administration whereas the half life of GLP-I is about half an hour.
  • Birgitte et al., J. CHn. Pharmacol 46:635-641, 2006; Jundsen, et al., J. Med. Chem. 43: 1664-1669, 2000; and Agerso, et al., Diabetologia 45:195-202, 2002.
  • Treatment with up to 0.75 mg injectable liraglutide once daily in patients with type H diabetes showed improved glycemic control while body weight remained stable.
  • Figure 1 3D plot showing the effect of EDTA and Me- ⁇ -CD.
  • Figure 2. PK data in rabbits with EDTA/Me- ⁇ -CD/DDPC intranasal formulations (Study 1).
  • the present invention fulfills foregoing needs and satisfies additional objects and advantages by providing novel, effective methods and compositions for mucosal, especially intranasal, delivery of a glucose-regulating peptide analogs, such as liraglutide, to treat diabetes mellitus, hyperglycemia, obesity, induce satiety in an individual and to promote weight-loss in an individual.
  • a glucose-regulating peptide analogs such as liraglutide
  • the enhanced delivery methods and compositions of the present invention provide for therapeutically effective mucosal delivery of the glucose-regulating peptide agonist for prevention or treatment of metabolic diseases such as obesity and eating disorders in mammalian subjects.
  • pharmaceutical formulations suitable for intranasal administration comprise a therapeutically effective amount of a glucose-regulating peptide and one or more intranasal delivery-enhancing agents as described herein, which formulations are effective in a nasal mucosal delivery method of the invention to prevent the onset or progression of obesity or eating disorders in a mammalian subject.
  • Nasal mucosal delivery of a therapeutically effective amount of a glucose-regulating peptide agonist and one or more intranasal delivery-enhancing agents yields elevated therapeutic levels of the glucose-regulating peptide agonist in the subject.
  • the enhanced delivery methods and compositions of the present invention provide for therapeutically effective mucosal delivery of a glucose-regulating peptide for prevention or treatment of a variety of diseases and conditions in mammalian subjects.
  • Glucose-regulating peptide can be administered via a variety of mucosal routes, for example by contacting the glucose-regulating peptide to a nasal mucosal epithelium, a bronchial or pulmonary mucosal epithelium, the oral buccal surface or the oral and small intestinal mucosal surface.
  • the methods and compositions are directed to or formulated for intranasal delivery (e.g., nasal mucosal delivery or intranasal mucosal delivery).
  • mucosal glucose-regulating peptide formulations and preparative and delivery methods of the invention provide improved mucosal delivery of a glucose-regulating peptide to mammalian subjects.
  • These compositions and methods can involve combinatorial formulation or coordinate administration of one or more glucose-regulating peptides with one or more mucosal delivery-enhancing agents.
  • mucosal delivery-enhancing agents to be selected from to achieve these formulations and methods are (A) solubilization agents; (B) charge modifying agents; (C) pH control agents; (D) degradative enzyme inhibitors; (E) mucolytic or mucus clearing agents; (F) ciliostatic agents; (G) membrane penetration-enhancing agents (e.g., (i) a surfactant; (ii) a bile salt; (iii) a phospholipid or fatty acid additive, mixed micelle, liposome, or carrier; (iv) an alcohol; (v) an enamine; (vi) a NO donor compound; (vii) a long-chain amphipathic molecule; (viii) a small hydrophobic penetration enhancer; (ix) sodium or a salicylic acid derivative; (x) a glycerol ester of acetoacetic acid; (xi) a cyclodextrin or beta-cyclodextrin derivative; (xii)
  • a glucose-regulating peptide is combined with one, two, three, four or more of the mucosal delivery-enhancing agents recited in (A)-(K) above.
  • These mucosal delivery-enhancing agents may be admixed, alone or together, with the glucose- regulating peptide, or otherwise combined therewith in a pharmaceutically acceptable formulation or delivery vehicle.
  • Formulation of a glucose-regulating peptide with one or more of the mucosal delivery-enhancing agents according to the teachings herein provides for increased bioavailability of the glucose-regulating binding peptide following delivery thereof to a mucosal surface of a mammalian subject.
  • the present invention is a method for suppressing appetite, promoting weight loss, decreasing food intake, or treating obesity and/or diabetes in a mammal comprising transmucosally administering a formulation comprised of a glucose-regulating peptide.
  • the present invention further provides for the use of a glucose-regulating peptide for the production of medicament for the transmucosal, administration of a glucose-regulating peptide for treating hyperglycemia, diabetes mellitus, metabolic syndrome, dyslipidemia, suppressing appetite, promoting weight loss, decreasing food intake, or treating obesity in a mammal.
  • a mucosally effective dose of glucose-regulating peptide within the pharmaceutical formulations of the present invention comprises, for example, between about a 1.25 to 1.9 mg dosage per day.
  • the pharmaceutical formulations of the present invention may be administered one or more times per day, or 3 times per week or once per week for between one week and at least 96 weeks or even for the life of the individual patient or subject.
  • the pharmaceutical formulations of the invention are administered one or more times daily, two times daily, four times daily, six times daily, or eight times daily.
  • Intranasal delivery-enhancing agents are employed which enhance delivery of a glucose- regulating peptide into or across a nasal mucosal surface.
  • the intranasal delivery-enhancing agent of the present invention may be a pH control agent.
  • the pH of the pharmaceutical formulation of the present invention is a factor affecting absorption of amylin via paracellular and transcellular pathways to drug transport.
  • the pharmaceutical formulation of the present invention is pH adjusted to between about pH 7 to 9. Generally, the pH is about 8.5 ⁇ 0.5.
  • the present invention provides improved methods and compositions for mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide to mammalian subjects for treatment or prevention of a variety of diseases and conditions.
  • appropriate mammalian subjects for treatment and prophylaxis according to the methods of the invention include, but are not restricted to, humans and non-human primates, livestock species, such as horses, cattle, sheep, and goats, and research and domestic species, including dogs, cats, mice, rats, guinea pigs, and rabbits.
  • GLP-I The amino acid sequence of GLP-I is given Le., by Schmidt, et al., Diabetologia 25:704-707, 1985.
  • Human GLP-I is a 37 amino acid residue peptide originating from preproglucagon which is synthesized, i.e., in the L-cells in the distal ileum, in the pancreas and in the brain. Processing of preproglucagon to GLP-I (7-36)amide, GLP-l(7-37) and GLP-2 occurs mainly in the L-cells.
  • GLP-l(7-37) and analogues thereof have attracted much attention in recent years only little is known about the structure of these molecules.
  • the secondary structure of GLP-I in micelles has been described by Thorton, et al, Biochemistry 33:3532-3539, 1994, but in normal solution, GLP-I is considered a very flexible molecule.
  • GLP-I and analogues of GLP-I and fragments thereof are useful i.e., in the treatment of Type 1 and Type 2 diabetes and obesity.
  • WO 87/06941 discloses GLP-I fragments, including GLP- 1(7-37), and functional derivatives thereof and to their use as an insulinotropic agent.
  • WO 90/11296 discloses GLP-I fragments, including GLP-l(7-36), and functional derivatives thereof which have an insulinotropic activity which exceeds the insulinotropic activity of GLP-l(l-36) or GLP-l(l-37) and to their use as insulinotropic agents.
  • WO 91/11457 discloses analogues of the active GLP-I peptides 7-34, 7-35, 7-36, and 7-37 which can also be useful as GLP-I moieties.
  • EP 0708179-A2 (Eli Lilly & Co.) discloses GLP-I analogues and derivatives that include an N-terminal imidazole group and optionally an unbranched Ce -Cio acyl group in attached to the lysine residue in position 34.
  • EP 0699686-A2 (Eli Lilly & Co.) discloses certain N-terminal truncated fragments of GLP-I that are reported to be biologically active.
  • the amino acid sequence of GLP-I (1-37) is: HDEFERHAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRG (SEQ ID NO: 1)
  • amino acid sequence of GLP-l(7-37) is: HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRG (SEQ ID NO: 2)
  • the amino acid sequence of GLP-I (7-36) is: HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGR (SEQ ID NO: 3)
  • the amino acid sequence of GLP-I (7-34) is:
  • HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVK (SEQ ID NO 4).
  • GLP-I 9-36
  • SEQ ID NO: 5 The amino acid sequence of GLP-I (9-36) is: EGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGR (SEQ ID NO: 5)
  • the GLP-I analogs listed below have enhanced DPP-IV resistance.
  • the amino acid sequence of the GLP-I analog GG is:
  • HGEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGR (SEQ ID NO: 6).
  • the amino acid sequence of the GLP-I analog GG 1 is: HGEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRPSS (SEQ ID NO: 7).
  • the amino acid sequence of the GLP-I analog GG 2 is: HGEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRPSSGAP (SEQ ID NO: 8).
  • the amino acid sequence of the GLP-I analog GG 3 is: HGEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRPSSGAPPPS (SEQ ID NO: 9).
  • the amino acid sequence of the GLP-I analog GLP-I ET is: HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGGPSSGAPPPS (SEQ ID NO: 10).
  • the amino acid sequence of the GLP-I synthetic analog NN2211 (liraglutide) is:
  • HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAK * EFIA WLVRGRG (SEQ ID NO: 11) where K * at position 26 of the amino acid chain is modified by acylation to generate a hexadecanoyl side chain (Le., K-JV 1 S- ( ⁇ -Glu (7V- ⁇ -hexadecanoyl).
  • the amino acid sequence of the GLP-I synthetic analog CJC-1131 is: HA * EGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRK * (SEQ ID NO: 12) where A * at position 8 of the amino acid chain is a D-alanine substituted for a L-alanine and the K * at position 37 of the amino acid chain has a [2-[2-[2-maleimidopropionamido(ethoxy)ethoxy]acetamide linker at its ⁇ amino group.
  • the amino acid sequence of the GLP-I synthetic analog LY315902 is: des- HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAREFIAWLVK * GRG (SEQ ID NO: 13) where the histidine residue at the N-terminus (des-H) does not contain an amino group and the K * at position 34 is modified by acylation to generate a octanoyl side chain (i.e., K-(octoanoyl)).
  • Mucosal delivery enhancing agents are defined as chemicals and other excipients that, when added to a formulation comprising water, salts and/or common buffers and glucose-regulating peptide (the control formulation) produce a formulation that produces a significant increase in transport of glucose-regulating peptide across a mucosa as measured by the maximum blood, serum, or cerebral spinal fluid concentration (C max ) or by the area under the curve, AUC, in a plot of concentration versus time.
  • a mucosa includes the nasal, oral, intestinal, buccal, bronchopulmonary, vaginal, and rectal mucosal surfaces and in fact includes all mucus- secreting membranes lining all body cavities or passages that communicate with the exterior. Mucosal delivery enhancing agents are sometimes called carriers. Endotoxin-free Formulation
  • Endotoxin-free formulation means a formulation which contains a glucose-regulating peptide and one or more mucosal delivery enhancing agents that is substantially free of endotoxins and/or related pyrogenic substances.
  • Endotoxins include toxins that are confined inside a microorganism and are released only when the microorganisms are broken down or die.
  • Pyrogenic substances include fever-inducing, thermostable substances (glycoproteins) from the outer membrane of bacteria and other microorganisms. Both of these substances can cause fever, hypotension and shock if administered to humans.
  • Producing formulations that are endotoxin- free can require special equipment, expert artisans, and can be significantly more expensive than making formulations that are not endotoxin-free.
  • Non-infused administration means any method of delivery that does not involve an injection directly into an artery or vein, a method which forces or drives (typically a fluid) into something and especially to introduce into a body part by means of a needle, syringe or other invasive method.
  • Non-infused administration includes subcutaneous injection, intramuscular injection, intraparitoneal injection and the non-injection methods of delivery to a mucosa.
  • the present invention provides mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide formulated with one or more mucosal delivery-enhancing agents wherein glucose-regulating peptide dosage release is substantially normalized and/or sustained for an effective delivery period of glucose-regulating peptide release ranges from approximately 0.1 to 2.0 hours; 0.4 to 1.5 hours; 0.7 to 1.5 hours; or 0.8 to 1.0 hours; following mucosal administration.
  • the sustained release of glucose-regulating peptide achieved may be facilitated by repeated administration of exogenous glucose-regulating peptide utilizing methods and compositions of the present invention.
  • the present invention provides improved mucosal (e.g., nasal) delivery of a formulation comprising glucose-regulating peptide in combination with one or more mucosal delivery-enhancing agents and an optional sustained release-enhancing agent or agents.
  • Mucosal delivery-enhancing agents of the present invention yield an effective increase in delivery, e.g., an increase in the maximal plasma concentration (C max ) to enhance the therapeutic activity of mucosally-administered glucose-regulating peptide.
  • C max maximal plasma concentration
  • a second factor affecting therapeutic activity of glucose-regulating peptide in the blood plasma and CNS is residence time (RT).
  • Sustained release-enhancing agents in combination with intranasal delivery-enhancing agents, increase C max and increase residence time (RT) of glucose-regulating peptide.
  • PEG polyethylene glycol
  • the present invention provides an improved glucose-regulating peptide delivery method and dosage form for treatment of symptoms related to obesity, diabetes, hyperglycemia, metabolic syndrome, coronary syndrome, colon cancer, exendin cancer, breast cancer, myocardial infraction, promoting neurogenesis, suppressing appetite, promoting weight loss, and decreasing food intake in mammalian subjects.
  • the glucose-regulating peptide is frequently combined or coordinately administered with a suitable carrier or vehicle for mucosal delivery.
  • carrier means pharmaceutically acceptable solid or liquid filler, diluent or encapsulating material.
  • a water-containing liquid carrier can contain pharmaceutically acceptable additives such as acidifying agents, alkalizing agents, antimicrobial preservatives, antioxidants, buffering agents, chelating agents, complexing agents, solubilizing agents, humectants, solvents, suspending and/or viscosity-increasing agents, tonicity agents, wetting agents or other biocompatible materials.
  • additives such as acidifying agents, alkalizing agents, antimicrobial preservatives, antioxidants, buffering agents, chelating agents, complexing agents, solubilizing agents, humectants, solvents, suspending and/or viscosity-increasing agents, tonicity agents, wetting agents or other biocompatible materials.
  • Some examples of the materials which can serve as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers are sugars, such as lactose, glucose and sucrose; starches such as corn starch and potato starch; cellulose and its derivatives such as sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; powdered tragacanth; malt; gelatin; talc; excipients such as cocoa butter and suppository waxes; oils such as peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil and soybean oil; glycols, such as propylene glycol; polyols such as glycerin, sorbitol, mannitol and polyethylene glycol; esters such as ethyl oleate and ethyl laurate; agar; buffering agents such as magnesium hydroxide and aluminum hydroxide; alginic acid; pyrogen free water; isotonic s, sorbitol, glucose and sucrose; starches
  • wetting agents such as sodium lauryl sulfate and magnesium stearate, as well as coloring agents, release agents, coating agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents, preservatives and antioxidants can also be present in the compositions, according to the desires of the formulator.
  • antioxidants examples include water soluble antioxidants such as ascorbic acid, cysteine hydrochloride, sodium bisulfite, sodium metabisulfite, sodium sulfite and the like; oil-soluble antioxidants such as ascorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole (BHA), butylated hydroxytoluene (BHT), lecithin, propyl gallate, alpha-tocopherol and the like; and metal- chelating agents such as citric acid, ethylenediamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA), sorbitol, tartaric acid, phosphoric acid and the like.
  • the amount of active ingredient that can be combined with the carrier materials to produce a single dosage form will vary depending upon the particular mode of administration.
  • various delivery-enhancing agents are employed which enhance delivery of glucose-regulating peptide into or across a mucosal surface.
  • delivery of glucose-regulating peptide across the mucosal epithelium can occur "transcellularly” or “paracellularly.”
  • the extent to which these pathways contribute to the overall flux and bioavailability of the glucose-regulating peptide depends upon the environment of the mucosa, the physico-chemical properties the active agent, and the properties of the mucosal epithelium. Paracellular transport involves only passive diffusion, whereas transcellular transport can occur by passive, facilitated or active processes.
  • hydrophilic, passively transported, polar solutes diffuse through the paracellular route, while more lipophilic solutes use the transcellular route.
  • Absorption and bioavailability e.g., as reflected by a permeability coefficient or physiological assay
  • the relative contribution of paracellular and transcellular pathways to drug transport depends upon the pKa, partition coefficient, molecular radius and charge of the drug, the pH of the luminal environment in which the drug is delivered, and the area of the absorbing surface.
  • the paracellular route represents a relatively small fraction of accessible surface area of the nasal mucosal epithelium.
  • cell membranes occupy a mucosal surface area that is a thousand times greater than the area occupied by the paracellular spaces.
  • the smaller accessible area, and the size- and charge-based discrimination against macromolecular permeation would suggest that the paracellular route would be a generally less favorable route than transcellular delivery for drug transport.
  • the methods and compositions of the invention provide for significantly enhanced transport of biotherapeutics into and across mucosal epithelia via the paracellular route. Therefore, the methods and compositions of the invention successfully target both paracellular and transcellular routes, alternatively or within a single method or composition.
  • mucosal delivery-enhancing agents include agents which enhance the release or solubility (e.g., from a formulation delivery vehicle), diffusion rate, penetration capacity and timing, uptake, residence time, stability, effective half-life, peak or sustained concentration levels, clearance and other desired mucosal delivery characteristics (e.g., as measured at the site of delivery, or at a selected target site of activity such as the bloodstream or central nervous system) of glucose-regulating peptide or other biologically active compound(s).
  • Enhancement of mucosal delivery can thus occur by any of a variety of mechanisms, for example by increasing the diffusion, transport, persistence or stability of glucose-regulating peptide, increasing membrane fluidity, modulating the availability or action of calcium and other ions that regulate intracellular or paracellular permeation, solubilizing mucosal membrane components (e.g., lipids), changing non-protein and protein sulfhydryl levels in mucosal tissues, increasing water flux across the mucosal surface, modulating epithelial junctional physiology, reducing the viscosity of mucus overlying the mucosal epithelium, reducing mucociliary clearance rates, and other mechanisms.
  • mucosal membrane components e.g., lipids
  • mucosal membrane components e.g., lipids
  • changing non-protein and protein sulfhydryl levels in mucosal tissues increasing water flux across the mucosal surface
  • modulating epithelial junctional physiology reducing the viscos
  • a "mucosally effective amount of glucose-regulating peptide” contemplates effective mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide to a target site for drug activity in the subject that may involve a variety of delivery or transfer routes.
  • a given active agent may find its way through clearances between cells of the mucosa and reach an adjacent vascular wall, while by another route the agent may, either passively or actively, be taken up into mucosal cells to act within the cells or be discharged or transported out of the cells to reach a secondary target site, such as the systemic circulation.
  • compositions of the invention may promote the translocation of active agents along one or more such alternate routes, or may act directly on the mucosal tissue or proximal vascular tissue to promote absorption or penetration of the active agent(s).
  • the promotion of absorption or penetration in this context is not limited to these mechanisms.
  • peak concentration (C max ) of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood plasma As used herein "peak concentration (C max ) of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood plasma”, "area under concentration vs. time curve (AUC) of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood plasma”, “time to maximal plasma concentration (t max ) of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood plasma” are pharmacokinetic parameters known to one skilled in the art. Laursen, et al., Eur. J. Endocrinology /35:309-315, 1996. The "concentration vs. time curve” measures the concentration of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood serum of a subject vs.
  • C max is the maximum concentration of glucose-regulating peptide in the blood serum of a subject following a single dosage of glucose-regulating peptide to the subject.
  • t max is the time to reach maximum concentration of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood serum of a subject following administration of a single dosage of glucose-regulating peptide to the subject.
  • AUC area under concentration vs. time curve
  • any significant changes in permeability of the mucosa be reversible within a time frame appropriate to the desired duration of drug delivery. Furthermore, there should be no substantial, cumulative toxicity, nor any permanent deleterious changes induced in the barrier properties of the mucosa with long-term use.
  • absorption-promoting agents for coordinate administration or combinatorial formulation with glucose-regulating peptide of the invention are selected from small hydrophilic molecules, including but not limited to, dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO), dimethylformamide, ethanol, propylene glycol, and the 2-pyrrolidones.
  • DMSO dimethyl sulfoxide
  • long-chain amphipathic molecules for example, deacylmethyl sulfoxide, azone, sodium laurylsulfate, oleic acid, and the bile salts, may be employed to enhance mucosal penetration of the glucose-regulating peptide.
  • surfactants e.g., polysorbates
  • Agents such as DMSO, polyethylene
  • I 2 glycol, and ethanol can, if present in sufficiently high concentrations in delivery environment (e.g., by pre-administration or incorporation in a therapeutic formulation), enter the aqueous phase of the mucosa and alter its solubilizing properties, thereby enhancing the partitioning of the glucose-regulating peptide from the vehicle into the mucosa.
  • Additional mucosal delivery-enhancing agents that are useful within the coordinate administration and processing methods and combinatorial formulations of the invention include, but are not limited to, mixed micelles; enamines; nitric oxide donors (e.g., S-nitroso-N-acetyl- DL-penicillamine, NORl, N0R4 ⁇ which are preferably co-administered with an NO scavenger such as carboxy-PUO or doclofenac sodium); sodium salicylate; glycerol esters of acetoacetic acid (e.g., glyceryl- 1,3-diacetoacetate or l ⁇ -isopropylideneglycerine-S-acetoacetate); and other release-diffusion or intra- or trans-epithelial penetration-promoting agents that are physiologically compatible for mucosal delivery.
  • nitric oxide donors e.g., S-nitroso-N-acetyl- DL-penicillamine,
  • absorption-promoting agents are selected from a variety of carriers, bases and excipients that enhance mucosal delivery, stability, activity or trans-epithelial penetration of the glucose-regulating peptide.
  • carriers, bases and excipients that enhance mucosal delivery, stability, activity or trans-epithelial penetration of the glucose-regulating peptide.
  • cyclodextrins and ⁇ -cyclodextrin derivatives e.g., 2-hydroxypropyl- ⁇ -cyclodextrin and heptakis(2,6-di-0-methyl- ⁇ -cyclodextrin).
  • cyclodextrins and ⁇ -cyclodextrin derivatives e.g., 2-hydroxypropyl- ⁇ -cyclodextrin and heptakis(2,6-di-0-methyl- ⁇ -cyclodextrin).
  • These compounds optionally conjugated with one or more of the active ingredients and further optionally formulated in an oleaginous base, enhance bioava
  • absorption- enhancing agents adapted for mucosal delivery include medium-chain fatty acids, including mono- and diglycerides (e.g., sodium caprate-extracts of coconut oil, Capmul), and triglycerides (e.g., amylodextrin, Estaram 299, Miglyol 810).
  • medium-chain fatty acids including mono- and diglycerides (e.g., sodium caprate-extracts of coconut oil, Capmul), and triglycerides (e.g., amylodextrin, Estaram 299, Miglyol 810).
  • the mucosal therapeutic and prophylactic compositions of the present invention may be supplemented with any suitable penetration-promoting agent that facilitates absorption, diffusion, or penetration of glucose-regulating peptide across mucosal barriers.
  • the penetration promoter may be any promoter that is pharmaceutically acceptable.
  • compositions that incorporate one or more penetration- promoting agents selected from sodium salicylate and salicylic acid derivatives (acetyl salicylate, choline salicylate, salicylamide, etc.); amino acids and salts thereof (e.g., monoaminocarboxlic acids such as glycine, alanine, phenylalanine, proline, hydroxyproline, etc.; hydroxyamino acids such as serine; acidic amino acids such as aspartic acid, glutamic acid, etc; and basic amino acids such as lysine etc — inclusive of their alkali metal or alkaline earth metal salts); and
  • amino acids and salts thereof e.g., monoaminocarboxlic acids such as glycine, alanine, phenylalanine, proline, hydroxyproline, etc.
  • hydroxyamino acids such as serine
  • acidic amino acids such as aspartic acid, glutamic acid, etc
  • basic amino acids such as lysine etc —
  • N-acetylamino acids N-acerylalanine, N-acetylphenylalanine, N-acetylserine, N-acetylglycine, N-acetyllysine, N-acetylglutamic acid, N-acetylproline, N-acetylhydroxyproline, etc.
  • salts alkali metal salts and alkaline earth metal salts
  • penetration-promoting agents within the methods and compositions of the invention are substances which are generally used as emulsifiers (e.g., sodium oleyl phosphate, sodium lauryl phosphate, sodium lauryl sulfate, sodium myristyl sulfate, polyoxyethylene alkyl ethers, poly oxy ethylene alkyl esters, etc.), caproic acid, lactic acid, malic acid and citric acid and alkali metal salts thereof, pyrrolidonecarboxylic acids, alkylpyrrolidonecarboxylic acid esters, N-alkylpyrrolidones, proline acyl esters, and the like.
  • emulsifiers e.g., sodium oleyl phosphate, sodium lauryl phosphate, sodium lauryl sulfate, sodium myristyl sulfate, polyoxyethylene alkyl ethers, poly oxy ethylene alkyl esters, etc.
  • caproic acid
  • improved nasal mucosal delivery formulations and methods allow delivery of glucose-regulating peptide and other therapeutic agents within the invention across mucosal barriers between administration and selected target sites.
  • Certain formulations are specifically adapted for a selected target cell, tissue or organ, or even a particular disease state.
  • formulations and methods provide for efficient, selective endo- or transcytosis of glucose-regulating peptide specifically routed along a defined intracellular or intercellular pathway.
  • the glucose-regulating peptide is efficiently loaded at effective concentration levels in a carrier or other delivery vehicle, and is delivered and maintained in a stabilized form, e.g., at the nasal mucosa and/or during passage through intracellular compartments and membranes to a remote target site for drug action (e.g., the blood stream or a defined tissue, organ, or extracellular compartment).
  • a remote target site for drug action e.g., the blood stream or a defined tissue, organ, or extracellular compartment.
  • the glucose-regulating peptide may be provided in a delivery vehicle or otherwise modified (e.g., in the form of a prodrug), wherein release or activation of the glucose-regulating peptide is triggered by a physiological stimulus (e.g., pH change, lysosomal enzymes, etc.)
  • a physiological stimulus e.g., pH change, lysosomal enzymes, etc.
  • the glucose-regulating peptide is pharmacologically inactive until it reaches its target site for activity.
  • the glucose-regulating peptide and other formulation components are non-toxic and non-immunogenic.
  • carriers and other formulation components are generally selected for their ability to be rapidly degraded and excreted under physiological conditions.
  • formulations are chemically and physically stable in dosage form for effective storage.
  • biologically active peptides and proteins for use within the invention are natural or synthetic, therapeutically or prophylactically active, peptides (comprised of two or more covalently linked amino acids), proteins, peptide or protein fragments, peptide or protein analogs, and chemically modified derivatives or salts of active peptides or proteins.
  • peptides compacted amino acids
  • proteins peptide or protein fragments
  • peptide or protein analogs peptide or protein analogs
  • chemically modified derivatives or salts of active peptides or proteins include glucose-regulating peptide are contemplated for use within the invention and can be produced and tested for biological activity according to known methods.
  • the peptides or proteins of glucose- regulating peptide or other biologically active peptides or proteins for use within the invention are muteins that are readily obtainable by partial substitution, addition, or deletion of amino acids within a naturally occurring or native (e.g., wild-type, naturally occurring mutant, or allelic variant) peptide or protein sequence. Additionally, biologically active fragments of native peptides or proteins are included. Such mutant derivatives and fragments substantially retain the desired biological activity of the native peptide or proteins. In the case of peptides or proteins having carbohydrate chains, biologically active variants marked by alterations in these carbohydrate species are also included within the invention.
  • the term "conservative amino acid substitution” refers to the general interchangeability of amino acid residues having similar side chains.
  • a commonly interchangeable group of amino acids having aliphatic side chains is alanine, valine, leucine, and isoleucine; a group of amino acids having aliphatic-hydroxyl side chains is serine and threonine; a group of amino acids having amide-containing side chains is asparagine and glutamine; a group of amino acids having aromatic side chains is phenylalanine, tyrosine, and tryptophan; a group of amino acids having basic side chains is lysine, arginine, and histidine; and a group of amino acids having sulfur-containing side chains is cysteine and methionine.
  • conservative substitutions include the substitution of a non-polar (hydrophobic) residue such as isoleucine, valine, leucine or methionine for another.
  • the present invention contemplates the substitution of a polar (hydrophilic) residue such as between arginine and lysine, between glutamine and asparagine, and between threonine and serine.
  • substitution of a basic residue such as lysine, arginine or histidine for another or the substitution of an acidic residue such as aspartic acid or glutamic acid for another is also contemplated.
  • Exemplary conservative amino acids substitution groups are: valine-leucine-isoleucine, phenylalanine- tyrosine, lysine-arginine, alanine-valine, and asparagine-glutamine.
  • An approach for stabilizing solid protein formulations of the invention is to increase the physical stability of purified, e.g., lyophilized protein. This will inhibit aggregation via hydrophobic interactions as well as via covalent pathways that may increase as proteins unfold.
  • Stabilizing formulations in this context often include polymer-based formulations, for example a biodegradable hydrogel formulation/delivery system.
  • polymer-based formulations for example a biodegradable hydrogel formulation/delivery system.
  • proteins are relatively stable in the solid state with bulk water removed.
  • solid therapeutic protein formulations may become hydrated upon storage at elevated humidities or during delivery from a sustained release composition or device. The stability of proteins generally drops with increasing hydration.
  • Water can also play a significant role in solid protein aggregation, for example, by increasing protein flexibility resulting in enhanced accessibility of reactive groups, by providing a mobile phase for reactants, and by serving as a reactant in several deleterious processes such as beta-elimination and hydrolysis.
  • Protein preparations containing between about 6% to 28% water are the most unstable. Below this level, the mobility of bound water and protein internal motions are low. Above this level, water mobility and protein motions approach those of full hydration. Up to a point, increased susceptibility toward solid-phase aggregation with increasing hydration has been observed in several systems. However, at higher water content, less aggregation is observed because of the dilution effect.
  • an effective method for stabilizing peptides and proteins against solid-state aggregation for mucosal delivery is to control the water content in a solid formulation and maintain the water activity in the formulation at optimal levels. This level depends on the nature of the protein, but in general, proteins maintained below their "monolayer" water coverage will exhibit superior solid-state stability.
  • additives that effectively control water content to enhance protein stability.
  • These reagents and carrier materials effective as anti-aggregation agents in this sense include, for example, polymers of various functionalities, such as polyethylene glycol, dextran, diethylaminoethyl dextran, and carboxymethyl cellulose, which significantly increase the stability and reduce the solid-phase aggregation of peptides and proteins admixed therewith or linked thereto.
  • the activity or physical stability of proteins can also be enhanced by various additives to aqueous solutions of the peptide or protein drugs.
  • additives such as polyols (including sugars), amino acids, proteins such as collagen and gelatin, and various salts may be used.
  • additives in particular sugars and other polyols, also impart significant physical stability to dry, e.g., lyophilized proteins.
  • These additives can also be used within the invention to protect the proteins against aggregation not only during lyophilization but also during storage in the dry state.
  • sucrose and Ficoll 70 a polymer with sucrose units
  • These additives may also enhance the stability of solid proteins embedded within polymer matrices.
  • additional additives for example sucrose, stabilize proteins against solid-state aggregation in humid atmospheres at elevated temperatures, as may occur in certain sustained- release formulations of the invention.
  • Proteins such as gelatin and collagen also serve as stabilizing or bulking agents to reduce denaturation and aggregation of unstable proteins in this context.
  • additives can be incorporated into polymeric melt processes and compositions within the invention.
  • polypeptide microparticles can be prepared by simply lyophilizing or spray drying a solution containing various stabilizing additives described above. Sustained release of unaggregated peptides and proteins can thereby be obtained over an extended period of time.
  • Various additional preparative components and methods, as well as specific formulation additives, are provided herein which yield formulations for mucosal delivery of aggregation- prone peptides and proteins, wherein the peptide or protein is stabilized in a substantially pure, unaggregated form using a solubilization agent.
  • a range of components and additives are contemplated for use within these methods and formulations.
  • Exemplary of these solubilization agents are cyclodextrins (CDs), which selectively bind hydrophobic side chains of polypeptides. These CDs have been found to bind to hydrophobic patches of proteins in a manner that significantly inhibits aggregation. This inhibition is selective with respect to both the CD and the protein involved.
  • Such selective inhibition of protein aggregation provides additional advantages within the intranasal delivery methods and compositions of the invention.
  • Additional agents for use in this context include CD dimers, trimers and tetramers with varying geometries controlled by the linkers that specifically block aggregation of peptides and protein.
  • solubilization agents and methods for incorporation within the invention involve the use of peptides and peptide mimetics to selectively block protein-protein interactions.
  • the specific binding of hydrophobic side chains reported for CD multimers is extended to proteins via the use of peptides and peptide mimetics that similarly block protein aggregation.
  • a wide range of suitable methods and anti-aggregation agents are available for incorporation within the compositions and procedures of the invention.
  • the invention also provides techniques and reagents for charge modification of selected biologically active agents or delivery-enhancing agents described herein.
  • biologically active agents including glucose-regulating peptide, other active peptides and proteins, and macromolecular and small molecule drugs
  • the relative permeabilities of macromolecules is generally be related to their partition coefficients.
  • Permeation and partitioning of biologically active agents for mucosal delivery may be facilitated by charge alteration or charge spreading of the active agent or permeabilizing agent, which is achieved, for example, by alteration of charged functional groups, by modifying the pH of the delivery vehicle or solution in which the active agent is delivered, or by coordinate administration of a charge- or pH-altering reagent with the active agent.
  • mucosal delivery of charged macromolecular species including glucose-regulating peptide and other biologically active peptides and proteins, within the methods and compositions of the invention is substantially improved when the active agent is delivered to the mucosal surface in a substantially un-ionized, or neutral, electrical charge state.
  • Certain glucose-regulating peptide and other biologically active peptide and protein components of mucosal formulations for use within the invention will be charge modified to yield an increase in the positive charge density of the peptide or protein. These modifications extend also to cationization of peptide and protein conjugates, carriers and other delivery forms disclosed herein. Cationization offers a convenient means of altering the biodistribution and transport properties of proteins and macromolecules within the invention. Cationization is undertaken in a manner that substantially preserves the biological activity of the active agent and limits potentially adverse side effects, including tissue damage and toxicity.
  • a “buffer” is generally used to maintain the pH of a solution at a nearly constant value.
  • a buffer maintains the pH of a solution, even when small amounts of strong acid or strong base are added to the solution, by preventing or neutralizing large changes in concentrations of hydrogen and hydroxide ions.
  • a buffer generally consists of a weak acid and its appropriate salt (or a weak base and its appropriate salt). The appropriate salt for a weak acid contains the same negative ion as present in the weak acid (see Lagowski, Macmillan Encyclopedia of Chemistry, Vol. 1, Simon & Schuster, New York, 1997, pp. 273-4).
  • the Henderson-Hasselbach Equation, pH pKa + loglO [A-]/[HA], is used to describe a buffer, and is based on the standard equation for weak acid dissociation, HA ⁇ H+ + A-.
  • buffer sources include the following: glutamate, acetate, citrate, glycine, histidine, arginine, lysine, methionine, lactate, formate, glycolate, tartrate, phosphate and mixtures thereof.
  • the “buffer capacity” means the amount of acid or base that can be added to a buffer solution before a significant pH change will occur. If the pH lies within the range of pK-1 and pK+1 of the weak acid the buffer capacity is appreciable, but outside this range it falls off to such an extent as to be of little value. Therefore, a given system only has a useful buffer action in a range of one pH unit on either side of the pK of the weak acid (or weak base) (see Dawson, Data for Biochemical Research, Third Edition, Oxford Science Publications, 1986, p. 419).
  • suitable concentrations are chosen so that the pH of the solution is close to the pKa of the weak acid (or weak base) (see Lide, CRC Handbook of Chemistry and Physics, 86th Edition, Taylor & Francis Group, 2005-2006, pp. 2-41). Further, solutions of strong acids and bases are not normally classified as buffer solutions, and they do not display buffer capacity between pH values 2.4 to 11.6.
  • a degradative enzyme inhibitor Another excipient that may be included in a trans-mucosal preparation is a degradative enzyme inhibitor.
  • exemplary mucoadhesive polymer-enzyme inhibitor complexes that are useful within the mucosal delivery formulations and methods of the invention include, but are not limited to: Carboxymethylcellulose-pepstatin (with anti-pepsin activity); Poly(acrylic acid)- Bowman-Birk inhibitor (anti-chymotrypsin); Poly(acrylic acid)-chymostatin (anti- chymotrypsin); Poly(acrylic acid)-elastatinal (anti-elastase); Carboxymethylcellulose-elastatinal (anti-elastase); Polycarbophil — elastatinal (anti-elastase); Chitosan — antipain (anti-trypsin); Poly(acrylic acid) — bacitracin (anti-aminopeptidase N); Chitos
  • certain embodiments of the invention will optionally incorporate a novel chitosan derivative or chemically modified form of chitosan.
  • One such novel derivative for use within the invention is denoted as a ⁇ -[l— »4]-2-guanidino-2-deoxy- D-glucose polymer (poly-GuD).
  • Any inhibitor that inhibits the activity of an enzyme to protect the biologically active agent(s) may be usefully employed in the compositions and methods of the invention.
  • Useful enzyme inhibitors for the protection of biologically active proteins and peptides include, for example, soybean trypsin inhibitor, exendin trypsin inhibitor, chymotrypsin inhibitor and trypsin and chrymotrypsin inhibitor isolated from potato (solanum tuberosum L.) tubers. A combination or mixtures of inhibitors may be employed.
  • Additional inhibitors of proteolytic enzymes for use within the invention include ovomucoid-enzyme, gabaxate mesylate, alpha 1 -antitrypsin, aprotinin, amastatin, bestatin, puromycin, bacitracin, leupepsin, alpha2-macroglobulin, pepstatin and egg white or soybean trypsin inhibitor. These and other inhibitors can be used alone or in combination.
  • the inhibitors may be incorporated in or bound to a carrier, e.g., a hydrophilic polymer, coated on the surface of the dosage form which is to contact the nasal mucosa, or incorporated in the superficial phase of the surface, in combination with the biologically active agent or in a separately administered (e.g., pre-administered) formulation.
  • a carrier e.g., a hydrophilic polymer
  • the amount of the inhibitor, e.g., of a proteolytic enzyme inhibitor that is optionally incorporated in the compositions of the invention will vary depending on (a) the properties of the specific inhibitor, (b) the number of functional groups present in the molecule (which may be reacted to introduce ethylenic unsaturation necessary for copolymerization with hydrogel forming monomers), and (c) the number of lectin groups, such as glycosides, which are present in the inhibitor molecule. It may also depend on the specific therapeutic agent that is intended to be administered.
  • a useful amount of an enzyme inhibitor is from about 0.1 mg/ml to about 50 mg/ml, often from about 0.2 mg/ml to about 25 mg/ml, and more commonly from about 0.5 mg/ml to 5 mg/ml of the of the formulation (i.e., a separate protease inhibitor formulation or combined formulation with the inhibitor and biologically active agent).
  • suitable inhibitors may be selected from, e.g., aprotinin, BBI, soybean trypsin inhibitor, chicken ovomucoid, chicken ovoinhibitor, human exendin trypsin inhibitor, camostat mesilate, flavonoid inhibitors, antipain, leupeptin , p-aminobenzamidine, AEBSF, TLCK (tosyllysine chloromethylketone), APMSF, DFP, PMSF, and poly(acrylate) derivatives.
  • aprotinin BBI
  • soybean trypsin inhibitor chicken ovomucoid
  • chicken ovoinhibitor human exendin trypsin inhibitor
  • camostat mesilate camostat mesilate
  • flavonoid inhibitors antipain
  • leupeptin p-aminobenzamidine
  • AEBSF TLCK (tosyllysine chloromethylketone)
  • APMSF DFP
  • PMSF
  • suitable inhibitors may be selected from, e.g., aprotinin, BBI, soybean trypsin inhibitor, chymostatin, benzyloxycarbonyl-Pro-Phe-CHO, FK-448, chicken ovoinhibitor, sugar biphenylboronic acids complexes, DFP, PMSF, ⁇ -phenylpropionate, and poly(acrylate) derivatives.
  • suitable inhibitors may be selected from, e.g., elastatinal, methoxysuccinyl-Ala-Ala-Pro-Val- chloromcthylkctonc (MPCMK), BBI, soybean trypsin inhibitor, chicken ovoinhibitor, DFP, and PMSF.
  • Additional enzyme inhibitors for use within the invention are selected from a wide range of non-protein inhibitors that vary in their degree of potency and toxicity. As described in further detail below, immobilization of these adjunct agents to matrices or other delivery vehicles, or development of chemically modified analogues, may be readily implemented to reduce or even eliminate toxic effects, when they are encountered.
  • organophosphorous inhibitors such as diisopropylfluorophosphate (DFP) and phenylmethylsulfonyl fluoride (PMSF), which are potent, irreversible inhibitors of serine proteases (e.g., trypsin and chymotrypsin).
  • AEBSF 4-(2-Aminoethyl)-benzenesulfonyl fluoride
  • AEBSF 4-(2-Aminoethyl)-benzenesulfonyl fluoride
  • AEBSF 4-(2-Aminoethyl)-benzenesulfonyl fluoride
  • APMSF (4-Aminophenyl)-methanesulfonyl fluoride hydrochloride
  • 4-(4- isopropylpiperadinocarbonyl)phenyl 1, 2,3,4, -tetrahydro-1-naphthoate methanesulphonate is a low toxic substance, representing a potent and specific inhibitor of chymotrypsin. Further representatives of this non-protein group of inhibitor candidates, and also exhibiting low toxic risk, are camostat mesilate (N,N'-dimethyl carbamoylmethyl-p-(p '-guanidino- benzoyloxy)phenylacetate methane-sulphonate).
  • amino acids and modified amino acids that interfere with enzymatic degradation of specific therapeutic compounds.
  • amino acids and modified amino acids are substantially non-toxic and can be produced at a low cost. However, due to their low molecular size and good solubility, they are readily diluted and absorbed in mucosal environments. Nevertheless, under proper conditions, amino acids can act as reversible, competitive inhibitors of protease enzymes. Certain modified amino acids can display a much stronger inhibitory activity.
  • a desired modified amino acid in this context is known as a 'transition-state' inhibitor.
  • Transition-state inhibitors are reversible, competitive inhibitors.
  • Examples of this type of inhibitor are ⁇ -aminoboronic acid derivatives, such as boro-leucine, boro-valine and boro-alanine.
  • the boron atom in these derivatives can form a tetrahedral boronate ion that is believed to resemble the transition state of peptides during their hydrolysis by aminopeptidases.
  • amino acid derivatives arc potent and reversible inhibitors of aminopeptidases and it is reported that boro-leucine is more than 100-times more effective in enzyme inhibition than bestatin and more than 1000-times more effective than puromycin.
  • Another modified amino acid for which a strong protease inhibitory activity has been reported is N-acetylcysteine, which inhibits enzymatic activity of aminopeptidase N.
  • This adjunct agent also displays mucolytic properties that can be employed within the methods and compositions of the invention to reduce the effects of the mucus diffusion barrier.
  • Still other useful enzyme inhibitors for use within the coordinate administration methods and combinatorial formulations of the invention may be selected from peptides and modified peptide enzyme inhibitors.
  • An important representative of this class of inhibitors is the cyclic dodecapeptide, bacitracin, obtained from Bacillus licheniformis.
  • certain dipeptides and tripeptides display weak, non-specific inhibitory activity towards some protease.
  • their inhibitory activity can be improved by chemical modifications.
  • phosphinic acid dipeptide analogues are also 'transition- state' inhibitors with a strong inhibitory activity towards aminopeptidases. They have reportedly been used to stabilize nasally administered leucine enkephalin.
  • modified pentapeptide pepstatin is a very potent inhibitor of pepsin. Structural analysis of pepstatin, by testing the inhibitory activity of several synthetic analogues, demonstrated the major structure-function characteristics of the molecule responsible for the inhibitory activity.
  • modified peptide includes inhibitors with a terminally located aldehyde function in their structure. For example, the sequence benzyloxycarbonyl-Pro-Phe-CHO, which fulfills the known primary and secondary specificity requirements of chymotrypsin, has been found to be a potent reversible inhibitor of this target proteinase.
  • polypeptide protease inhibitors are more amenable than smaller compounds to concentrated delivery in a drug-carrier matrix.
  • Additional agents for protease inhibition within the formulations and methods of the invention involve the use of complexing agents. These agents mediate enzyme inhibition by depriving the intranasal environment (or preparative or therapeutic composition) of divalent cations, which are co-factors for many proteases.
  • the complexing agents EDTA and DTPA as coordinately administered or combinatorially formulated adjunct agents, in suitable concentration will be sufficient to inhibit selected proteases to thereby enhance intranasal delivery of biologically active agents according to the invention.
  • inhibitory agents are EGTA, 1,10-phenanthroline and hydroxychinoline.
  • these and other complexing agents are useful within the invention as direct, absorption-promoting agents.
  • polymers particularly mucoadhesive polymers, as enzyme inhibiting agents within the coordinate administration, multi-processing and/or combinatorial formulation methods and compositions of the invention.
  • poly(acrylate) derivatives such as poly(acrylic acid) and polycarbophil, can affect the activity of various proteases, including trypsin, chymotrypsin.
  • the inhibitory effect of these polymers may also be based on the complexation of divalent cations such as Ca 2+ and Zn 2+ . It is further contemplated that these polymers may serve as conjugate partners or carriers for additional enzyme inhibitory agents, as described above.
  • a chitosan-EDTA conjugate has been developed and is useful within the invention that exhibits a strong inhibitory effect towards the enzymatic activity of zinc-dependent proteases.
  • the mucoadhesive properties of polymers following covalent attachment of other enzyme inhibitors in this context are not expected to be substantially compromised, nor is the general utility of such polymers as a delivery vehicle for biologically active agents within the invention expected to be diminished.
  • the reduced distance between the delivery vehicle and mucosal surface afforded by the mucoadhesive mechanism will minimize presystemic metabolism of the active agent, while the covalently bound enzyme inhibitors remain concentrated at the site of drug delivery, minimizing undesired dilution effects of inhibitors as well as toxic and other side effects caused thereby.
  • the effective amount of a coordinately administered enzyme inhibitor can be reduced due to the exclusion of dilution effects.
  • Exemplary mucoadhesive polymer-enzyme inhibitor complexes that are useful within the mucosal formulations and methods of the invention include, but are not limited to:
  • Carboxymethylcellulose-pepstatin (with anti-pepsin activity); Poly(acrylic acid)-Bowman-Birk inhibitor (anti-chymotrypsin); Poly(acrylic acid)-chymostatin (anti-chymotrypsin); Poly(acrylic acid)-elastatinal (anti-elastase); Carboxymethylcellulose-elastatinal (anti-elastase); Polycarbophil — elastatinal (anti-elastase); Chitosan — antipain (anti-trypsin); Poly(acrylic acid) — bacitracin (anti-aminopeptidase N); Chitosan — EDTA (anti-aminopeptidase N, anti-carboxypeptidase A); Chitosan — EDTA — antipain (anti-trypsin, anti-chymotrypsin, anti-elastase).
  • mucus is a viscoelastic, gel-like substance consisting of water, electrolytes, mucins, macromolecules, and sloughed epithelial cells. It serves primarily as a cytoprotective and lubricative covering for the underlying mucosal tissues. Mucus is secreted by randomly distributed secretory cells located in the nasal epithelium and in other mucosal epithelia. The structural unit of mucus is mucin.
  • This glycoprotein is mainly responsible for the viscoelastic nature of mucus, although other macromolecules may also contribute to this property.
  • macromolecules include locally produced secretory IgA, IgM, IgE, lysozyme, and bronchotransferrin, which also play an important role in host defense mechanisms.
  • the coordinate administration methods of the instant invention optionally incorporate effective mucolytic or mucus-clearing agents, which serve to degrade; thin or clear mucus from intranasal mucosal surfaces to facilitate absorption of intranasally administered biotherapeutic agents.
  • a mucolytic or mucus-clearing agent is coordinately administered as an adjunct compound to enhance intranasal delivery of the biologically active agent.
  • an effective amount of a mucolytic or mucus-clearing agent is incorporated as a processing agent within a multi-processing method of the invention, or as an additive within a combinatorial formulation of the invention, to provide an improved formulation that enhances intranasal delivery of biotherapeutic compounds by reducing the barrier effects of intranasal mucus.
  • mucolytic and mucus clearing agents can often be classified into the following groups: proteases (e.g., pronase, papain) that cleave the protein core of mucin glycoproteins; sulfhydryl compounds that split mucoprotein disulfide linkages; and detergents (e.g., Triton X-IOO, Tween 20) that break non-covalent bonds within the mucus.
  • proteases e.g., pronase, papain
  • sulfhydryl compounds that split mucoprotein disulfide linkages
  • detergents e.g., Triton X-IOO, Tween 20
  • Additional compounds in this context include, but are not limited to, bile salts and surfactants, for example, sodium deoxycholate, sodium taurodeoxycholate, sodium glycocholate, and lysophosphatidylcholine.
  • bile salts in causing structural breakdown of mucus is in the order deoxycholate > taurocholate > glycocholate.
  • Other effective agents that reduce mucus viscosity or adhesion to enhance intranasal delivery according to the methods of the invention include, e.g., short-chain fatty acids, and mucolytic agents that work by chelation, such as N-acylcollagen peptides, bile acids, and saponins (the latter function in part by chelating Ca 2+ and/or Mg 2+ which play an important role in maintaining mucus layer structure).
  • Additional mucolytic agents for use within the methods and compositions of the invention include N-acetyl-L-cysteine (ACS), a potent mucolytic agent that reduces both the viscosity and adherence of bronchopulmonary mucus and is reported to modestly increase nasal bioavailability of human growth hormone in anesthetized rats (from 7.5 to 12.2%).
  • ACS N-acetyl-L-cysteine
  • These and other mucolytic or mucus-clearing agents are contacted with the nasal mucosa, typically in a concentration range of about 0.2 to 20 mM, coordinately with administration of the biologically active agent, to reduce the polar viscosity and/or elasticity of intranasal mucus.
  • mucolytic or mucus-clearing agents may be selected from a range of glycosidase enzymes, which are able to cleave glycosidic bonds within the mucus glycoprotein, ⁇ -amylase and ⁇ -amylase are representative of this class of enzymes, although their mucolytic effect may be limited.
  • bacterial glycosidases which allow these microorganisms to permeate mucus layers of their hosts.
  • non-ionogenic detergents are generally also useful as mucolytic or mucus-clearing agents. These agents typically will not modify or substantially impair the activity of therapeutic polypeptides.
  • Viscosity enhancing or suspending agents may affect the rate of release of a drug from the dosage formulation and absorption.
  • Some examples of the materials which can serve as pharmaceutically acceptable viscosity enhancing agents are methylcellulose (MC); hydroxypropylmeihylcellulose (HPMC); carboxymethylcellulose (CMC); cellulose; gelatin; starch; heta starch; poloxamers; pluronics; sodium CMC; sorbitol; acacia; povidone; carbopol; polycarbophil; chitosan; chitosan microspheres; alginate microspheres; chitosan glutamate; amberlite resin; hyaluronan; ethyl cellulose; maltodextrin DE; drum-dried way maize starch (DDWM); degradable starch microspheres (DSM); deoxyglycocholate (GDC); hydroxyethyl cellulose (HEC); hydroxypropyl cellulose (HPC); microcrystalline
  • mucosal tissues e.g., nasal mucosal tissues
  • mucociliary clearance e.g., to remove dust, allergens, and bacteria
  • mucociliary transport in the respiratory tract is a particularly important defense mechanism against infections. To achieve this function, ciliary beating in the nasal and airway passages moves a layer of mucus along the mucosa to removing inhaled particles and microorganisms.
  • Ciliostatic agents find use within the methods and compositions of the invention to increase the residence time of mucosally (e.g., intranasally) administered glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein.
  • the delivery these agents within the methods and compositions of the invention is significantly enhanced in certain aspects by the coordinate administration or combinatorial formulation of one or more ciliostatic agents that function to reversibly inhibit ciliary activity of mucosal cells, to provide for a temporary, reversible increase in the residence time of the mucosally administered active agent(s).
  • the foregoing ciliostatic factors are all candidates for successful employment as ciliostatic agents in appropriate amounts (depending on concentration, duration and mode of delivery) such that they yield a transient (i.e., reversible) reduction or cessation of mucociliary clearance at a mucosal site of administration to enhance delivery of glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein, without unacceptable adverse side effects.
  • Various bacterial ciliostatic factors isolated and characterized in the literature may be employed within the embodiments of the invention.
  • Ciliostatic factors from the bacterium Pseudomonas aeruginosa include a phenazine derivative, a pyo compound (2-alkyl-4- hydroxyquinolines), and a rhamnolipid (also known as a hemolysin).
  • the pyo compound produced ciliostasis at concentrations of 50 ⁇ g/ml and without obvious ultrastructural lesions.
  • the phenazine derivative also inhibited ciliary motility but caused some membrane disruption, although at substantially greater concentrations of 400 ⁇ g/ml. Limited exposure of tracheal explants to the rhamnolipid resulted in ciliostasis, which is associated with altered ciliary membranes. More extensive exposure to rhamnolipid is associated with removal of dynein arms from axonemes.
  • one or more membrane penetration- enhancing agents may be employed within a mucosal delivery method or formulation of the invention to enhance mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein.
  • Membrane penetration enhancing agents in this context can be selected from: (i) a surfactant, (ii) a bile salt, (iii) a phospholipid additive, mixed micelle, liposome, or carrier, (iv) an alcohol, (v) an enamine, (vi) a NO donor compound, (vii) a long-chain amphipathic molecule (viii) a small hydrophobic penetration enhancer; (ix) sodium or a salicylic acid derivative; (x) a glycerol ester of acetoacetic acid, (xi) a clyclodextrin or beta-cyclodextrin derivative, (xii) a medium-chain fatty acid, (xiii) a chelating agent, (xiv) an amino acid or salt thereof, (xv) an N-acetylamino acid or salt thereof, (xvi) an enzyme degradative to a selected membrane component, (xvii) an inhibitor of fatty acid synthesis,
  • Certain surface-active agents are readily incorporated within the mucosal delivery formulations and methods of the invention as mucosal absorption enhancing agents. These agents, which may be coordinately administered or combinatorially formulated with glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein, may be selected from a broad assemblage of known surfactants. Surfactants, which generally fall into three classes: (1) nonionic polyoxyethylene ethers; (2) bile salts such as sodium glycocholate (SGC) and deoxycholate (DOC); and (3) derivatives of fusidic acid such as sodium taurodihydrofusidate (STDHF). The mechanisms of action of these various classes of surface-active agents typically include solubilization of the biologically active agent.
  • SGC sodium glycocholate
  • DOC deoxycholate
  • STDHF sodium taurodihydrofusidate
  • the surface active properties of these absorption promoters can allow interactions with proteins such that smaller units such as surfactant coated monomers may be more readily maintained in solution.
  • examples of other surface-active agents are L- ⁇ -Phosphatidylcholine Didecanoyl (DDPC) polysorbate 80 and polysorbate 20. These monomers are presumably more transportable units than aggregates.
  • DDPC L- ⁇ -Phosphatidylcholine Didecanoyl
  • a second potential mechanism is the protection of the peptide or protein from proteolytic degradation by proteases in the mucosal environment. Both bile salts and some fusidic acid derivatives reportedly inhibit proteolytic degradation of proteins by nasal homogenates at concentrations less than or equivalent to those required to enhance protein absorption. This protease inhibition may be especially important for peptides with short biological half-lives.
  • glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents for mucosal administration are formulated or coordinately administered with a penetration enhancing agent selected from a degradation enayme, or a metabolic stimulatory agent or inhibitor of synthesis of fatty acids, sterols or other selected epithelial barrier components, U.S. Patent No. 6,190,894.
  • degradative en ⁇ ymes such as phospholipase, hyaluronidase, neuraminidase, and chondroitinase may be employed to enhance mucosal penetration of glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agent without causing irreversible damage to the mucosal barrier.
  • chondroitinase is employed within a method or composition as provided herein to alter glycoprotein or glycolipid constituents of the permeability barrier of the mucosa, thereby enhancing mucosal absorption of glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein.
  • free fatty acids account for 20-25% of epithelial lipids by weight.
  • Two rate-limiting enzymes in the biosynthesis of free fatty acids are acetyl CoA carboxylase and fatty acid synthetase. Through a series of steps, free fatty acids are metabolized into phospholipids.
  • inhibitors of free fatty acid synthesis and metabolism for use within the methods and compositions of the invention include, but are not limited to, inhibitors of acetyl CoA carboxylase such as 5-tetradecyloxy-2- furancarboxylic acid (TOFA); inhibitors of fatty acid synthetase; inhibitors of phospholipase A such as gomisin A, 2-(p-amylcinnamyl)amino-4-chlorobenzoic acid, bromophenacyl bromide, monoalide, 7,7-dimethyl-5,8-eicosadienoic acid, nicergoline, cepharanthine, nicardipine, quercetin, dibutyryl-cyclic AMP, R-24571, N-oleoylethanolamine, N-(7-nitro-2,l,3- benzoxadiazol-4-yl) phosphostidyl serine, cyclosporine A, topical anesthetics, including dibuca
  • HMG 3-hydroxy-3-methylglutaryl
  • Inhibitors of cholesterol synthesis for use within the methods and compositions of the invention include, but are not limited to, competitive inhibitors of (HMG) CoA reductase, such as simvastatin, lovastatin, fluindostatin (fluvastatin), pravastatin, mevastatin, as well as other HMG CoA reductase inhibitors, such as cholesterol oleate, cholesterol sulfate and phosphate, and oxygenated sterols, such as 25-OH— and 26-OH-- cholesterol; inhibitors of squalene synthetase; inhibitors of squalene epoxidase; inhibitors of DELTA7 or DELTA24 reductases such as 22,25-diazacholesterol, 20,
  • Each of the inhibitors of fatty acid synthesis or the sterol synthesis inhibitors may be coordinately administered or combinatorially formulated with one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein to achieve enhanced epithelial penetration of the active agent(s).
  • An effective concentration range for the sterol inhibitor in a therapeutic or adjunct formulation for mucosal delivery is generally from about 0.0001% to about 20% by weight of the total, more typically from about 0.01% to about 5%.
  • a nitric oxide (NO) donor is selected as a membrane penetration-enhancing agent to enhance mucosal delivery of one or more glucose- regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein.
  • NO donors are known in the art and are useful in effective concentrations within the methods and formulations of the invention.
  • Exemplary NO donors include, but are not limited to, nitroglycerine, nitropruside, N0C5 [3-(2-hydroxy ⁇ l-(methyl-ethyl)-2- nitrosohydrazino)- 1 -propanamine] , NOC 12 [N-ethyl-2-( 1 -ethyl-hydroxy-2-nitrosohydrazino)- ethanamine], SNAP [S-nitroso-N-acetyl-DL-penicillamine], NORI and N0R4.
  • an effective amount of a selected NO donor is coordinately administered or combinatorially formulated with one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and/or other biologically active agents disclosed herein, into or through the mucosal epithelium.
  • the present invention provides pharmaceutical composition that contains one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs or mimetics, and/or other biologically active agents in combination with mucosal delivery enhancing agents disclosed herein formulated in a pharmaceutical preparation for mucosal delivery.
  • the permeabilizing agent reversibly enhances mucosal epithelial paracellular transport, typically by modulating epithelial junctional structure and/or physiology at a mucosal epithelial surface in the subject.
  • This effect typically involves inhibition by the permeabilizing agent of homotypic or heterotypic binding between epithelial membrane adhesive proteins of neighboring epithelial cells.
  • Target proteins for this blockade of homotypic or heterotypic binding can be selected from various related junctional adhesion molecules (JAMs), occludins, or claudins. Examples of this are antibodies, antibody fragments or single-chain antibodies that bind to the extracellular domains of these proteins.
  • the invention provides permeabilizing peptides and peptide analogs and mimetics for enhancing mucosal epithelial paracellular transport.
  • the subject peptides and peptide analogs and mimetics typically work within the compositions and methods of the invention by modulating epithelial junctional structure and/or physiology in a mammalian subject.
  • the peptides and peptide analogs and mimetics effectively inhibit homotypic and/or heterotypic binding of an epithelial membrane adhesive protein selected from a junctional adhesion molecule (JAM), occludin, or claudin.
  • JAM junctional adhesion molecule
  • ZOT zonula occludens toxin
  • This toxin mediates increased intestinal mucosal permeability and causes disease symptoms including diarrhea in infected subjects. Fasano, et al., Proc. Nat. Acad. ScI, U.S.A. 5:5242-5246, 1991.
  • ZOT increased the intestinal permeability by modulating the structure of intercellular tight junctions. More recently, it has been found that ZOT is capable of reversibly opening tight junctions in the intestinal mucosa. It has also been reported that ZOT is capable of reversibly opening tight junctions in the nasal mucosa.
  • ZOT as well as various analogs and mimetics of ZOT that function as agonists or antagonists of ZOT activity, are useful for enhancing intranasal delivery of biologically active agents — by increasing paracellular absorption into and across the nasal mucosa.
  • ZOT typically acts by causing a structural reorganization of tight junctions marked by altered localization of the junctional protein ZOl.
  • ZOT is coordinately administered or combinatorially formulated with the biologically active agent in an effective amount to yield significantly enhanced absorption of the active agent, by reversibly increasing nasal mucosal permeability without substantial adverse side effects.
  • vasoactive compounds More specifically vasodilators. These compounds function within the invention to modulate the structure and physiology of the submucosal vasculature, increasing the transport rate of glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents into or through the mucosal epithelium and/or to specific target tissues or compartments (e.g., the systemic circulation or central nervous system.).
  • Vasodilator agents for use within the invention typically cause submucosal blood vessel relaxation by either a decrease in cytoplasmic calcium, an increase in nitric oxide (NO) or by inhibiting myosin light chain kinase.
  • They are generally divided into 9 classes: calcium antagonists, potassium channel openers, ACE inhibitors, angiotensin-II receptor antagonists, ⁇ - adrenergic and imidazole receptor antagonists, ⁇ l -adrenergic agonists, phosphodiesterase inhibitors, eicosanoids and NO donors.
  • calcium antagonists potassium channel openers
  • ACE inhibitors angiotensin-II receptor antagonists
  • ⁇ - adrenergic and imidazole receptor antagonists ⁇ l -adrenergic agonists
  • phosphodiesterase inhibitors eicosanoids and NO donors.
  • ACE inhibitors prevent conversion of angiotensin-I to angiotensin-II, and are most effective when renin production is increased. Since ACE is identical to kininase-II, which inactivates the potent endogenous vasodilator bradykinin, ACE inhibition causes a reduction in bradykinin degradation. ACE inhibitors provide the added advantage of cardioprotective and cardioreparative effects, by preventing and reversing cardiac fibrosis and ventricular hypertrophy in animal models. The predominant elimination pathway of most ACE inhibitors is via renal excretion. Therefore, renal impairment is associated with reduced elimination and a dosage reduction of 25 to 50% is recommended in patients with moderate to severe renal impairment.
  • NO donors these compounds are particularly useful within the invention for their additional effects on mucosal permeability.
  • complexes of NO with nucleophiles called NO/nucleophiles, or NONOates, spontaneously and nonen2ymatically release NO when dissolved in aqueous solution at physiologic pH.
  • NO/nucleophiles or NONOates
  • NONOates release NO with a defined stoichiometry and at predictable rates ranging from ⁇ 3 minutes for diethylamine/NO to approximately 20 hours for diethylenetriamine/NO (DETANO).
  • a selected vasodilator agent is coordinately administered (e.g., systemically or intranasally, simultaneously or in combinatorially effective temporal association) or combinatorially formulated with one or more glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agent(s) in an amount effective to enhance the mucosal absorption of the active agent(s) to reach a target tissue or compartment in the subject (e.g., the liver, hepatic portal vein, CNS tissue or fluid, or blood plasma).
  • a target tissue or compartment in the subject e.g., the liver, hepatic portal vein, CNS tissue or fluid, or blood plasma.
  • compositions and delivery methods of the invention optionally incorporate a selective transport-enhancing agent that facilitates transport of one or more biologically active agents.
  • transport-enhancing agents may be employed in a combinatorial formulation or coordinate administration protocol with one or more of the glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics disclosed herein, to coordinately enhance delivery of one or more additional biologically active agent(s) across mucosal transport barriers, to enhance mucosal delivery of the active agent(s) to reach a target tissue or compartment in the subject (e.g., the mucosal epithelium, liver, CNS tissue or fluid, or blood plasma).
  • a target tissue or compartment in the subject e.g., the mucosal epithelium, liver, CNS tissue or fluid, or blood plasma.
  • the transport- enhancing agents may be employed in a combinatorial formulation or coordinate administration protocol to directly enhance mucosal delivery of one or more of the glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, with or without enhanced delivery of an additional biologically active agent.
  • Exemplary selective transport-enhancing agents for use within this aspect of the invention include, but are not limited to, glycosides, sugar-containing molecules, and binding agents such as lectin binding agents, which are known to interact specifically with epithelial transport barrier components.
  • binding agents such as lectin binding agents, which are known to interact specifically with epithelial transport barrier components.
  • specific "bioadhesive" ligands including various plant and bacterial lectins, which bind to cell surface sugar moieties by receptor-mediated interactions can be employed as carriers or conjugated transport mediators for enhancing mucosal, e.g., nasal delivery of biologically active agents within the invention.
  • bioadhesive ligands for use within the invention will mediate transmission of biological signals to epithelial target cells that trigger selective uptake of the adhesive ligand by specialized cellular transport processes (endocytosis or transcytosis).
  • These transport mediators can therefore be employed as a "carrier system” to stimulate or direct selective uptake of one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agent(s) into and/or through mucosal epithelia.
  • These and other selective transport-enhancing agents significantly enhance mucosal delivery of macromolecular biopharmaceuticals (particularly peptides, proteins, oligonucleotides and polynucleotide vectors) within the invention.
  • Lectins are plant proteins that bind to specific sugars found on the surface of glycoproteins and glycolipids of eukaryotic cells. Concentrated solutions of lectins have a 'mucotractive' effect, and various studies have demonstrated rapid receptor mediated endocytocis (RME) of lectins and lectin conjugates (e.g., concanavalin A conjugated with colloidal gold particles) across mucosal surfaces. Additional studies have reported that the uptake mechanisms for lectins can be utilized for intestinal drug targeting in vivo. In certain of these studies, polystyrene nanoparticles (500 run) were covalently coupled to tomato lectin and reported yielded improved systemic uptake after oral administration to rats.
  • RME receptor mediated endocytocis
  • microbial adhesion and invasion factors provide a rich source of candidates for use as adhesive/selective transport carriers within the mucosal delivery methods and compositions of the invention.
  • Two components are necessary for bacterial adherence processes, a bacterial 'adhesin' (adherence or colonization factor) and a receptor on the host cell surface.
  • Bacteria causing mucosal infections need to penetrate the mucus layer before attaching themselves to the epithelial surface. This attachment is usually mediated by bacterial fimbriae or pilus structures, although other cell surface components may also take part in the process.
  • Adherent bacteria colonize mucosal epithelia by multiplication and initiation of a series of biochemical reactions inside the target cell through signal transduction mechanisms (with or without the help of toxins).
  • signal transduction mechanisms with or without the help of toxins.
  • bioadhesive proteins e.g., invasin, interaalin
  • Such naturally occurring phenomena may be harnessed (e.g., by complexing biologically active agents such as glucose- regulating peptide with an adhesin) according to the teachings herein for enhanced delivery of biologically active compounds into or across mucosal epithelia and/or to other designated target sites of drug action.
  • biologically active agents such as glucose-regulating peptide with an adhesin
  • diptheria toxin enters host cells rapidly by RME.
  • the B subunit of the E. coli heat labile toxin binds to the brush border of intestinal epithelial cells in a highly specific, lectin- like manner. Uptake of this toxin and transcytosis to the basolateral side of the enterocytes has been reported in vivo and in vitro. Other researches have expressed the transmembrane domain of diphtheria toxin in E.
  • Staphylococcus aureus produces a set of proteins (e.g., staphylococcal enterotoxin A (SEA), SEB, toxic shock syndrome toxin 1 (TSST-I) which act both as superantigens and toxins. Studies relating to these proteins have reported dose-dependent, facilitated transcytosis of SEB and TSST-I in Caco-2 cells.
  • SEA staphylococcal enterotoxin A
  • SEB SEB
  • TSST-I toxic shock syndrome toxin 1
  • Viral haemagglutinins comprise another type of transport agent to facilitate mucosal delivery of biologically active agents within the methods and compositions of the invention.
  • the initial step in many viral infections is the binding of surface proteins (haemagglutinins) to mucosal cells. These binding proteins have been identified for most viruses, including rotaviruses, varicella zoster virus, semliM forest virus, adenoviruses, potato leafroll virus, and reovirus.
  • viral hemagglutinins can be employed in a combinatorial formulation (e.g., a mixture or conjugate formulation) or coordinate administration protocol with one or more of the glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics disclosed herein, to coordinately enhance mucosal delivery of one or more additional biologically active agent(s).
  • viral hemagglutinins can be employed in a combinatorial formulation or coordinate administration protocol to directly enhance mucosal delivery of one or more of the glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, with or without enhanced delivery of an additional biologically active agent.
  • a variety of endogenous, selective transport-mediating factors are also available for use within the invention.
  • phagocytosis phagocytosis
  • pinocytosis receptor-mediated endocytosis
  • potocytosis non-clathrin-mediated RME.
  • RME is a highly specific cellular biologic process by which, as its name implies, various ligands bind to cell surface receptors and are subsequently internalized and trafficked within the cell. In many cells the process of endocytosis is so active that the entire membrane surface is internalized and replaced in less than a half hour.
  • Two classes of receptors are proposed based on their orientation in the cell membrane; the amino terminus of Type I receptors is located on the extracellular side of the membrane, whereas Type II receptors have this same protein tail in the intracellular milieu.
  • Transferrin as a carrier or stimulant of RME of mucosally delivered biologically active agents.
  • Transferrin an 80 kDa iron-transporting glycoprotein, is efficiently taken up into cells by RME.
  • Transferrin receptors are found on the surface of most proliferating cells, in elevated numbers on erythroblasts and on many kinds of tumors.
  • the transcytosis of transferrin (Tf) and transferrin conjugates is reportedly enhanced in the presence of Brefeldin A (BFA), a fungal metabolite.
  • BFA Brefeldin A
  • BFA and other agents that stimulate receptor-mediated transport can be employed within the methods of the invention as combinatorially formulated (e.g., conjugated) and/or coordinately administered agents to enhance receptor-mediated transport of biologically active agents, including glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics.
  • glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, other biologically active agents disclosed herein, and delivery-enhancing agents as described above are, individually or combinatorially, incorporated within a mucosally (e.g., nasally) administered formulation that includes a biocompatible polymer functioning as a carrier or base.
  • a biocompatible polymer functioning as a carrier or base.
  • Such polymer carriers include polymeric powders, matrices or microparticulate delivery vehicles, among other polymer forms.
  • the polymer can be of plant, animal, or synthetic origin. Often the polymer is crosslinked.
  • the glucose-regulating peptide, analog or mimetic can be functionalized in a manner where it can be covalently bound to the polymer and rendered inseparable from the polymer by simple ishing.
  • the polymer is chemically modified with an inhibitor of enzymes or other agents which may degrade or inactivate the biologically active agent(s) and/or delivery enhancing agent(s).
  • the polymer is a partially or completely water insoluble but water swellable polymer, e.g., ahydrogel.
  • Polymers useful in this aspect of the invention are desirably water interactive and/or hydrophilic in nature to absorb significant quantities of water, and they often form hydrogels when placed in contact with water or aqueous media for a period of time sufficient to reach equilibrium with water.
  • the polymer is a hydrogel which, when placed in contact with excess water, absorbs at least two times its weight of water at equilibrium when exposed to water at room temperature, U.S. Patent No. 6,004,583.
  • Biodegradable polymers such as poly(glycolic acid) (PGA), poly-(lactic acid) (PLA), and poly(D,L-lactic-co-glycolic acid) (PLGA), have received considerable attention as possible drug delivery carriers, since the degradation products of these polymers have been found to have low toxicity. During the normal metabolic function of the body these polymers degrade into carbon dioxide and water. These polymers have also exhibited excellent biocompatibility.
  • glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein, as well as optional delivery- enhancing agents these agents may be incorporated into polymeric matrices, e.g., polyorthoesters, polyanhydrides, or polyesters. This yields sustained activity and release of the active agent(s), e.g., as determined by the degradation of the polymer matrix.
  • polymeric matrices e.g., polyorthoesters, polyanhydrides, or polyesters.
  • This yields sustained activity and release of the active agent(s), e.g., as determined by the degradation of the polymer matrix e.g., as determined by the degradation of the polymer matrix.
  • the encapsulation of biotherapeutic molecules inside synthetic polymers may stabilize them during storage and delivery, the largest obstacle of polymer-based release technology is the activity loss of the therapeutic molecules during the formulation processes that often involve heat, sonication or organic solvents.
  • Absorption-promoting polymers contemplated for use within the invention may include derivatives and chemically or physically modified versions of the foregoing types of polymers, in addition to other naturally occurring or synthetic polymers, gums, resins, and other agents, as well as blends of these materials with each other or other polymers, so long as the alterations, modifications or blending do not adversely affect the desired properties, such as water absorption, hydrogel formation, and/or chemical stability for useful application.
  • polymers such as nylon, acrylan and other normally hydrophobic synthetic polymers may be sufficiently modified by reaction to become water swellable and/or form stable gels in aqueous media.
  • Absorption-promoting polymers of the invention may include polymers from the group of homo- and copolymers based on various combinations of the following vinyl monomers: acrylic and methacrylic acids, acrylamide, methacrylamide, hydroxyethylacrylate or methacrylate, vinylpyrrolidones, as well as polyvinylalcohol and its co- and terpolymers, polyvinylacetate, its co- and terpolymers with the above listed monomers and 2-acrylamido-2- methyl-propanesulfonic acid (AMPS®).
  • vinyl monomers acrylic and methacrylic acids, acrylamide, methacrylamide, hydroxyethylacrylate or methacrylate, vinylpyrrolidones, as well as polyvinylalcohol and its co- and terpolymers, polyvinylacetate, its co- and terpolymers with the above listed monomers and 2-acrylamido-2- methyl-propanesulfonic acid (AMPS®).
  • copolymers of the above listed monomers with copolymerizable functional monomers such as acryl or methacryl amide acrylate or methacrylate esters where the ester groups are derived from straight or branched chain alkyl, aryl having up to four aromatic rings which may contain alkyl substituents of 1 to 6 carbons; steroidal, sulfates, phosphates or cationic monomers such as N,N-dimethylaminoalkyl(meth)acrylamide, dimethylaminoalkyl(meth)acrylate, (meth)acryloxyalkyltrimethylammonium chloride, (meth)acryloxyalkyldimethylben2yl ammonium chloride.
  • functional monomers such as acryl or methacryl amide acrylate or methacrylate esters where the ester groups are derived from straight or branched chain alkyl, aryl having up to four aromatic rings which may contain alkyl substituents of 1 to 6 carbons; steroidal,
  • Additional absorption-promoting polymers for use within the invention are those classified as dextrans, dextrins, and from the class of materials classified as natural gums and resins, or from the class of natural polymers such as processed collagen, chitin, chitosan, pullalan, zooglan, alginates and modified alginates such as "Kelcoloid” (a polypropylene glycol modified alginate) gellan gums such as "Kelocogel”, Xanathan gums such as "Keltrol”, estastin, alpha hydroxy butyrate and its copolymers, hyaluronic acid and its derivatives, polylactic and glycolic acids.
  • Kelcoloid a polypropylene glycol modified alginate
  • Xanathan gums such as "Keltrol”
  • estastin, alpha hydroxy butyrate and its copolymers hyaluronic acid and its derivatives, polylactic and glycolic acids.
  • a very useful class of polymers applicable within the instant invention are olefinically- unsaturated carboxylic acids containing at least one activated carbon-to-carbon olef ⁇ nic double bond, and at least one carboxyl group; that is, an acid or functional group readily converted to an acid containing an olefinic double bond which readily functions in polymerization because of its presence in the monomer molecule, either in the alpha-beta position with respect to a carboxyl group, or as part of a terminal methylene grouping.
  • Olefinically-unsaturated acids of this class include such materials as the acrylic acids typified by the acrylic acid itself, alpha-cyano acrylic acid, beta methylacrylic acid (crotonic acid), alpha-phenyl acrylic acid, beta-acryloxy propionic acid, cinnamic acid, p-chloro cinnamic acid, l-carboxy-4-phenyl butadiene- 1,3, itaconic acid, citraconic acid, mesaconic acid, glutaconic acid, aconitic acid, maleic acid, fumaric acid, and tricarboxy ethylene.
  • acrylic acids typified by the acrylic acid itself, alpha-cyano acrylic acid, beta methylacrylic acid (crotonic acid), alpha-phenyl acrylic acid, beta-acryloxy propionic acid, cinnamic acid, p-chloro cinnamic acid, l-carboxy-4-phenyl butadiene- 1,3, itaconic acid,
  • carboxylic acid includes the polycarboxylic acids and those acid anhydrides, such as maleic anhydride, wherein the anhydride group is formed by the elimination of one molecule of water from two carboxyl groups located on the same carboxylic acid molecule.
  • acrylates useful as absorption-promoting agents within the invention include methyl acrylate, ethyl acrylate, propyl acrylate, isopropyl acrylate, butyl acrylate, isobutyl acrylate, methyl methacrylate, methyl ethacrylate, ethyl methacrylate, octyl acrylate, heptyl acrylate, octyl methacrylate, isopropyl methacrylate, 2-ethylhexyl methacrylate, nonyl acrylate, hexyl acrylate, n-hexyl methacrylate, and the like.
  • Higher alkyl acrylic esters are decyl acrylate, isodecyl methacrylate, lauryl acrylate, stearyl acrylate, behenyl acrylate and melissyl acrylate and methacrylate versions thereof. Mixtures of two or three or more long chain acrylic esters may be successfully polymerized with one of the carboxylic monomers.
  • Other comonomers include olefins, including alpha olefins, vinyl ethers, vinyl esters, and mixtures thereof.
  • vinylidene monomers including the acrylic nitriles, may also be used as absorption-promoting agents within the methods and compositions of the invention to enhance delivery and absorption of one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agent(s), including to enhance delivery of the active agent(s) to a target tissue or compartment in the subject (e.g., the liver, hepatic portal vein, CNS tissue or fluid, or blood plasma).
  • Useful alpha, beta-olefinically unsaturated nitriles are preferably monoolefinically unsaturated nitriles having from 3 to 10 carbon atoms such as acrylonitrile, methacrylonitrile, and the like.
  • Acrylic amides containing from 3 to 35 carbon atoms including monoolefinically unsaturated amides also may be used.
  • Representative amides include acrylamide, methacrylamide, N-t-butyl acrylamide, N-cyclohexyl acrylamide, higher alkyl amides, where the alkyl group on the nitrogen contains from 8 to 32 carbon atoms, acrylic amides including N-alkylol amides of alpha, beta-olefinically unsaturated carboxylic acids including those having from 4 to 10 carbon atoms such as N-methylol acrylamide, N-propanol acrylamide, N-methylol methacrylamide, N-methylol maleimide, N-methylol maleamic acid esters, N-methylol-p-vinyl benzamide, and the like.
  • hydrogels When hydrogels are employed as absorption promoting agents within the invention, these may be composed of synthetic copolymers from the group of acrylic and methacrylic acids, acrylamide, methacrylamide, hydroxyethylacrylate (HEA) or methacrylate (HEMA), and vinylpyrrolidones which are water interactive and swellable.
  • HOA hydroxyethylacrylate
  • HEMA methacrylate
  • vinylpyrrolidones vinylpyrrolidones which are water interactive and swellable.
  • Specific illustrative examples of useful polymers, especially for the delivery of peptides or proteins, are the following types of polymers: (meth)acrylamide and 0.1 to 99 wt.
  • alkyl means C 1 to C3o, preferably C 1 to C 22 , linear and branched and C 4 to C ⁇ cyclic; where (meth) is used, it means that the monomers with and without the methyl group are included.
  • Other very useful hydrogel polymers are swellable, but insoluble versions of poly(vinyl pyrrolidone) starch, carboxymethyl cellulose and polyvinyl alcohol.
  • Additional polymeric hydrogel materials useful within the invention include (poly) hydroxyalkyl (meth)acrylate: anionic and cationic hydrogels: poly(electrolyte) complexes; poly(vinyl alcohols) having a low acetate residual: a swellable mixture of crosslinked agar and crosslinked carboxymethyl cellulose: a swellable composition comprising methyl cellulose mixed with a sparingly crosslinked agar; a water swellable copolymer produced by a dispersion of finely divided copolymer of maleic anhydride with styrene, ethylene, propylene, or isobutylene; a water swellable polymer of N-vinyl lactams; swellable sodium salts of carboxymethyl cellulose; and the like.
  • Synthetic hydrogel polymers for use within the invention may be made by an infinite combination of several monomers in several ratios.
  • the hydrogel can be crosslinked and generally possesses the ability to imbibe and absorb fluid and swell or expand to an enlarged equilibrium state.
  • the hydrogel typically swells or expands upon delivery to the nasal mucosal surface, absorbing about 2-5, 5-10, 10-50, up to 50-100 or more times fold its weight of water.
  • the optimum degree of swellability for a given hydrogel will be determined for different biologically active agents depending upon such factors as molecular weight, size, solubility and diffusion characteristics of the active agent carried by or entrapped or encapsulated within the polymer, and the specific spacing and cooperative chain motion associated with each individual polymer.
  • Hydrophilic polymers useful within the invention are water insoluble but water swellable.
  • Such water-swollen polymers as typically referred to as hydrogels or gels.
  • Such gels may be conveniently produced from water-soluble polymer by the process of crosslinking the polymers by a suitable crosslinking agent.
  • stable hydrogels may also be formed from specific polymers under defined conditions of pH, temperature and/or ionic concentration, according to known methods in the art.
  • the polymers are cross-linked to the extent that the polymers possess good hydrophilic properties, have improved physical integrity (as compared to non cross-linked polymers of the same or similar type) and exhibit improved ability to retain within the gel network both the biologically active agent of interest and additional compounds for coadministration therewith such as a cytokine or enzyme inhibitor, while retaining the ability to release the active agent(s) at the appropriate location and time.
  • hydrogel polymers for use within the invention are crosslinked with a difunctional cross-linking in the amount of from 0.01 to 25 weight percent, based on the weight of the monomers forming the copolymer, and more preferably from 0.1 to 20 weight percent and more often from 0.1 to 15 weight percent of the crosslinking agent.
  • Another useful amount of a crosslinking agent is 0.1 to 10 weight percent.
  • Tri, tetra or higher multifunctional crosslinking agents may also be employed. When such reagents are utilized, lower amounts may be required to attain equivalent crosslinking density, i.e., the degree of crosslinking, or network properties that are sufficient to contain effectively the biologically active agent(s).
  • crosslinks can be covalent, ionic or hydrogen bonds with the polymer possessing the ability to swell in the presence of water containing fluids.
  • Such crosslinkers and crosslinking reactions are known to those skilled in the art and in many cases are dependent upon the polymer system.
  • a crosslinked network may be formed by free radical copolymerization of unsaturated monomers.
  • Polymeric hydrogels may also be formed by crosslinking preformed polymers by reacting functional groups found on the polymers such as alcohols, acids, amines with such groups as glyoxal, formaldehyde or glutaraldehyde, bis anhydrides and the like.
  • the polymers also may be cross-linked with any polyene, e.g.
  • decadiene or trivinyl cyclohexane acrylamides, such as N,N-methylene-bis (acrylamide); polyfunctional acrylates, such as trimethylol propane triacrylate; or polyfunctional vinylidene monomer containing at least 2 terminal CH 2 ⁇ groups, including, for example, divinyl benzene, divinyl naphthlene, allyl acrylates and the like.
  • cross-linking monomers for use in preparing the copolymers are polyalkenyl polyethers having more than one alkenyl ether grouping per molecule, which may optionally possess alkenyl groups in which an olefinic double bond is present attached to a terminal methylene grouping (e.g., made by the etherification of a polyhydric alcohol containing at least 2 carbon atoms and at least 2 hydroxyl groups).
  • alkenyl halide such as allyl chloride or allyl bromide
  • the product may be a complex mixture of polyethers with varying numbers of ether groups. Efficiency of the polyether cross-linking agent increases with the number of potentially polymerizable groups on the molecule. Typically, polyethers containing an average of two or more alkenyl ether groupings per molecule are used.
  • Other cross-linking monomers include for example, diallyl esters, dimethallyl ethers, allyl or methallyl acrylates and acrylamides, tetravinyl silane, polyalkenyl methanes, diacrylates, and dimethacrylates, divinyl compounds such as divinyl benzene, polyallyl phosphate, diallyloxy compounds and phosphite esters and the like.
  • Typical agents are allyl pentaerythritol, allyl sucrose, trimethylolpropane triacrylate, 1,6-hexanediol diacrylate, trimethylolpropane diallyl ether, pentaerythritol triacrylate, tetramethylene dimethacrylate, ethylene diacrylate, ethylene dimethacrylate, triethylene glycol dimethacrylate, and the like. Allyl pentaerythritol, trimethylolpropane diallylether and allyl sucrose provide suitable polymers.
  • the cross-linking agent When the cross-linking agent is present, the polymeric mixtures usually contain between about 0.01 to 20 weight percent, e.g., 1%, 5%, or 10% or more
  • mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein is enhanced by retaining the active agent(s) in a slow-release or enzymatically or physiologically protective carrier or vehicle, for example a hydrogel that shields the active agent from the action of the degradative enzymes.
  • the active agent is bound by chemical means to the carrier or vehicle, to which may also be admixed or bound additional agents such as enzyme inhibitors, cytokines, etc.
  • the active agent may alternately be immobilized through sufficient physical entrapment within the carrier or vehicle, e.g., a polymer matrix.
  • Polymers such as hydrogels useful within the invention may incorporate functional linked agents such as glycosides chemically incorporated into the polymer for enhancing intranasal bioavailability of active agents formulated therewith.
  • functional linked agents such as glycosides chemically incorporated into the polymer for enhancing intranasal bioavailability of active agents formulated therewith.
  • glycosides are glucosides, fructosides, galactosides, arabinosides, mannosides and their alkyl substituted derivatives and natural glycosides such as arbutin, phlorizin, amygdalin, digitonin, saponin, and indican.
  • the hydrogen of the hydroxyl groups of a glycoside or other similar carbohydrate may be replaced by the alkyl group from a hydrogel polymer to form an ether.
  • the hydroxyl groups of the glycosides may be reacted to esterify the carboxyl groups of a polymeric hydrogel to form polymeric esters in situ.
  • Another approach is to employ condensation of acetobromoglucose with cholest-5-en-3beta-ol on a copolymer of maleic acid.
  • N-substituted polyacrylamides can be synthesized by the reaction of activated polymers with omega- aminoalkylglycosides: (1) (carbohydrate-spacer)(n)-polyacrylamide, 'pseudopolysaccharides'; (2) (carbohydrate spacer)(n)-phosphatidylethanolamine(m)-polyacrylamide, neoglycolipids, derivatives of phosphatidylethanolamine; (3) (carbohydrate-spacer)(n)-biotin(m)- polyacrylamide.
  • These biotinylated derivatives may attach to lectins on the mucosal surface to facilitate absorption of the biologically active agent(s), e.g., a polymer-encapsulated glucose- regulating peptide.
  • one or more glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and/or other biologically active agents, disclosed herein, optionally including secondary active agents such as protease inhibitor(s), cytokine(s), additional modulator(s) of intercellular junctional physiology, etc. are modified and bound to a polymeric carrier or matrix. For example, this may be accomplished by chemically binding a peptide or protein active agent and other optional agent(s) within a crosslinked polymer network. It is also possible to chemically modify the polymer separately with an interactive agent such as a
  • the biologically active agent(s), and optional secondary active agent(s) may be functionalized, i.e., wherein an appropriate reactive group is identified or is chemically added to the active agent(s). Most often an ethylenic polymerizable group is added, and the functionalized active agent is then copolymerized with monomers and a crosslmking agent using a standard polymerization method such as solution polymerization (usually in water), emulsion, suspension or dispersion polymerization. Often, the functionalizing agent is provided with a high enough concentration of functional or polymerizable groups to insure that several sites on the active agent(s) are functionalized.
  • the functionalized active agent(s) is/are mixed with monomers and a crosslmking agent that comprise the reagents from which the polymer of interest is formed. Polymerization is then induced in this medium to create a polymer containing the bound active agent(s). The polymer is then combined with water or other appropriate solvents and otherwise purified to remove trace unreacted impurities and, if necessary, ground or broken up by physical means such as by stirring, forcing it through a mesh, ultrasonication or other suitable means to a desired particle size.
  • the solvent usually water
  • One desired method is lyophilization (freeze drying) but other methods are available and may be used (e.g., vacuum drying, air drying, spray drying, etc.).
  • lyophilization freeze drying
  • other methods are available and may be used (e.g., vacuum drying, air drying, spray drying, etc.).
  • unsaturated monomers containing N-hydroxy succinimidyl groups active carbonates such as p-nitrophenyl carbonate, trichlorophenyl carbonates, tresylate, oxycarbonylimidazoles, epoxide, isocyanates and aldehyde, and unsaturated carboxymethyl azides and unsaturated orthopyridyl-disulfide belong to this category of reagents.
  • active carbonates such as p-nitrophenyl carbonate, trichlorophenyl carbonates, tresylate, oxycarbonylimidazoles, epoxide, isocyanates and aldehyde
  • unsaturated carboxymethyl azides and unsaturated orthopyridyl-disulfide belong to this category of reagents.
  • unsaturated reagents are allyl glycidyl ether, allyl chloride, allylbromide, allyl iodide, acryloyl chloride, allyl isocyanate, allylsulfonyl chloride, maleic anhydride, copolymers of maleic anhydride and allyl ether, and the like.
  • All of the lysine active derivatives can generally react with other amino acids such as imidazole groups of histidine and hydroxyl groups of tyrosine and the thiol groups of cystine if the local environment enhances nucleophilicity of these groups.
  • Aldehyde containing functionalizing reagents are specific to lysine. These types of reactions with available groups from lysines, cysteines, tyrosine have been extensively documented in the literature and are known to those skilled in the art.
  • an acyloyl chloride such as acryloyl chloride, and introduce the polymerizable acrylic group onto the reacted agent. Then during preparation of the polymer, such as during the crosslinking of the copolymer of acrylamide and acrylic acid, the functionalized active agent, through the acrylic groups, is attached to the polymer and becomes bound thereto.
  • biologically active agents including peptides, proteins, nucleosides, and other molecules which are bioactive in vivo, are conjugation-stabilized by covalently bonding one or more active agent(s) to a polymer incorporating as an integral part thereof both a hydrophilic moiety, e.g., a linear polyalkylene glycol, a lipophilic moiety (see, e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,681,811).
  • a biologically active agent is covalently coupled with a polymer comprising (i) a linear polyalkylene glycol moiety, and (ii) a lipophilic moiety, wherein the active agent, linear polyalkylene glycol moiety, and the lipophilic moiety are conformationally arranged in relation to one another such that the active therapeutic agent has an enhanced in vivo resistance to enzymatic degradation (i.e., relative to its stability under similar conditions in an unconjugated form devoid of the polymer coupled thereto).
  • the conjugation-stabilized formulation has a three-dimensional conformation comprising the biologically active agent covalently coupled with a polysorbate complex comprising (i) a linear polyalkylene glycol moiety, and (ii) a lipophilic moiety, wherein the active agent, the linear polyalkylene glycol moiety and the lipophilic moiety are conformationally arranged in relation to one another such that (a) the lipophilic moiety is exteriorly available in the three-dimensional conformation, and (b) the active agent in the composition has an enhanced in vivo resistance to enzymatic degradation.
  • a polysorbate complex comprising (i) a linear polyalkylene glycol moiety, and (ii) a lipophilic moiety, wherein the active agent, the linear polyalkylene glycol moiety and the lipophilic moiety are conformationally arranged in relation to one another such that (a) the lipophilic moiety is exteriorly available in the three-dimensional conformation, and (b) the active agent in the composition has an enhanced in
  • a multiligand conjugated complex which comprises a biologically active agent covalently coupled with a triglyceride backbone moiety through a polyalkylene glycol spacer group bonded at a carbon atom of the triglyceride backbone moiety, and at least one fatty acid moiety covalently attached either directly to a carbon atom of the triglyceride backbone moiety or covalently joined through a polyalkylene glycol spacer moiety (see, e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,681,811).
  • the alpha' and beta carbon atoms of the triglyceride bioactive moiety may have fatty acid moieties attached by covalently bonding either directly thereto, or indirectly covalently bonded thereto through polyalkylene glycol spacer moieties.
  • a fatty acid moiety may be covalently attached either directly or through a polyalkylene glycol spacer moiety to the alpha and alpha' carbons of the triglyceride backbone moiety, with the bioactive therapeutic agent being covalently coupled with the gamma-carbon of the triglyceride backbone moiety, either being directly covalently bonded thereto or indirectly bonded thereto through a polyalkylene spacer moiety.
  • the multiligand conjugated therapeutic agent complex comprising the triglyceride backbone moiety, within the scope of the invention.
  • the biologically active agent(s) may advantageously be covalently coupled with the triglyceride modified backbone moiety through alkyl spacer groups, or alternatively other acceptable spacer groups, within the scope of the invention.
  • acceptability of the spacer group refers to steric, compositional, and end use application specific acceptability characteristics.
  • a conjugation-stabilized complex which comprises a polysorbate complex comprising a polysorbate moiety including a triglyceride backbone having covalently coupled to alpha, alpha 1 and beta carbon atoms thereof functionalizing groups including (i) a fatty acid group; and (ii) a polyethylene glycol group having a biologically active agent or moiety covalently bonded thereto, e.g., bonded to an appropriate functionality of the polyethylene glycol group.
  • Such covalent bonding may be either direct, e.g., to a hydroxy terminal functionality of the polyethylene glycol group, or alternatively, the covalent bonding may be indirect, e.g., by reactively capping the hydroxy terminus of the polyethylene glycol group with a terminal carboxy functionality spacer group, so that the resulting capped polyethylene glycol group has a terminal carboxy functionality to which the biologically active agent or moiety may be covalently bonded.
  • a stable, aqueously soluble, conjugation- stabilized complex which comprises one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and/or other biologically active agent(s)+ disclosed herein covalently coupled to a physiologically compatible polyethylene glycol (PEG) modified glycolipid moiety.
  • the biologically active agent(s) may be covalently coupled to the physiologically compatible PEG modified glycolipid moiety by a labile covalent bond at a free amino acid group of the active agent, wherein the labile covalent bond is scissionable in vivo by biochemical hydrolysis and/or proteolysis.
  • the physiologically compatible PEG modified glycolipid moiety may advantageously comprise a polysorbate polymer, e.g., a polysorbate polymer comprising fatty acid ester groups selected from the group consisting of monopalmitate, dipalmitate, monolaurate, dilaurate, trilaurate, monoleate, dioleate, trioleate, monostearate, distearate, and tristearate.
  • a polysorbate polymer e.g., a polysorbate polymer comprising fatty acid ester groups selected from the group consisting of monopalmitate, dipalmitate, monolaurate, dilaurate, trilaurate, monoleate, dioleate, trioleate, monostearate, distearate, and tristearate.
  • the physiologically compatible PEG modified glycolipid moiety may suitably comprise a polymer selected from the group consisting of polyethylene glycol ethers of fatty acids, and polyethylene glycol esters of fatty acids, wherein the fatty acids for example comprise a fatty acid selected from the group consisting of lauric, palmitic, oleic, and stearic acids.
  • the nasal spray product manufacturing process generally includes the preparation of a diluent for glucose-regulating peptide nasal spray, which includes ⁇ 85% water plus the components of the nasal spray formulation without glucose-regulating peptide.
  • the pH of the diluent is then measured and adjusted with sodium hydroxide or hydrochloric acid, if necessary.
  • the glucose-regulating peptide nasal spray is prepared by the non-aseptic transfer of ⁇ 85% of the final target volume of the diluent to a screw cap bottle. An appropriate amount of glucose- regulating peptide is added and mixed until completely dissolved.
  • the pH is measured and adjusted with sodium hydroxide or hydrochloric acid, if necessary. A sufficient quantity of diluent is added to reach the final target volume.
  • Screw-cap bottles are filled and caps affixed.
  • the above description of the manufacturing process represents a method used to prepare the initial clinical batches of drug product. This method may be modified during the development process to optimize the manufacturing process.
  • Parenteral administration including glucose-regulating peptide for injection or infusion, requires a sterile (aseptic) manufacturing process compliance with FDA regulations.
  • Current Good Manufacturing Practices (GMP) for sterile drug manufacturing include standards for design and construction features (21 C.F.R. ⁇ 211.42 (April 1, 2005)); standards for testing and approval or rejection of components, drug product containers, and closures ( ⁇ 211.84); standards for control of microbiological contamination ( ⁇ 211.113); and other special testing requirements ( ⁇ 211.167).
  • Non-parenteral (non-aseptic) products such as the intranasal product of the invention, do not require these specialized sterile manufacturing conditions.
  • the requirements for a sterile manufacturing process are substantially higher and correspondingly more costly than those required for a non-sterile product manufacturing process.
  • These costs include much greater capitalization costs for facilities, as well as a more costly manufacturing cost: extra facilites for sterile manufacturing include additional rooms and ventilation; extra costs associated with sterile manufacturing include greater manpower, extensive quality control and quality assurance, and administrative support.
  • manufacturing costs of an intranasal glucose-regulating peptide product such as that of the invention, are far less than those of a parenterally administered glucose-regulating peptide product.
  • the present invention satisfies the need for a non-sterile manufacturing process for glucose-regulating peptides.
  • Sterile solutions can be prepared by incorporating the active compound in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filtered sterilization.
  • dispersions are prepared by incorporating the active compound into a sterile vehicle that contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above.
  • methods of preparation include vacuum drying and freeze-drying which yields a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof.
  • the prevention of the action of microorganisms can be accomplished by various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, sorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like.
  • the combinatorial formulations and/or coordinate administration methods herein incorporate an effective amount of peptides and proteins which may adhere to charged glass thereby reducing the effective concentration in the container.
  • Silanized containers for example, silanized glass containers, are used to store the finished product to reduce adsorption of the polypeptide or protein to a glass container.
  • a kit for treatment of a mammalian subject comprises a stable pharmaceutical composition of one or more glucose-regulating peptide compound(s) formulated for mucosal delivery to the mammalian subject wherein the composition is effective to alleviate one or more symptom(s) of diabetes, obesity, cancer,hyperglycemia, dyslipidemia, metabolic syndrome, coronary syndrome, myocardial infraction, or neurological disorder in said subject without unacceptable adverse side effects.
  • the kit further comprises a pharmaceutical reagent vial to contain the one or more glucose- regulating peptide compounds.
  • the pharmaceutical reagent vial is composed of pharmaceutical grade polymer, glass or other suitable material.
  • the pharmaceutical reagent vial is, for example, a silanized glass vial.
  • the kit further comprises an aperture for delivery of the composition to a nasal mucosal surface of the subject.
  • the delivery aperture is composed of a pharmaceutical grade polymer, glass or other suitable material.
  • the delivery aperture is, for example, a silanized glass.
  • a silanization technique combines a special cleaning technique for the surfaces to be silanized with a silanization process at low pressure.
  • the silane is in the gas phase and at an enhanced temperature of the surfaces to be silanized.
  • the method provides reproducible surfaces with stable, homogeneous and functional silane layers having characteristics of a monolayer.
  • the silanized surfaces prevent binding to the glass of polypeptides or mucosal delivery enhancing agents of the present invention.
  • the procedure is useful to prepare silanized pharmaceutical reagent vials to hold glucose- regulating peptide compositions of the present invention.
  • Glass trays are cleaned by rinsing with double distilled water (ddH 2 O) before using.
  • the silane tray is then be rinsed with 95% EtOH, and the acetone tray is rinsed with acetone.
  • Pharmaceutical reagent vials are sonicated in acetone for 10 minutes. After the acetone sonication, reagent vials are ished in ddH 2 O tray at least twice.
  • Reagent vials are sonicated in 0.1M NaOH for 10 minutes. While the reagent vials are sonicating in NaOH, the silane solution is made under a hood.
  • reagent vials are ished in ddH 2 O tray at least twice.
  • the reagent vials are sonicated in silane solution for 3 to 5 minutes.
  • the reagent vials are ished in 100% EtOH tray.
  • the reagent vials are dried with prepurified N 2 gas and stored in a 100°C oven for at least 2 hours before using.
  • the combinatorial formulations and/or coordinate administration methods herein incorporate an effective amount of a nontoxic bioadhesive as an adjunct compound or carrier to enhance mucosal delivery of one or more biologically active agent(s).
  • Bioadhesive agents in this context exhibit general or specific adhesion to one or more components or surfaces of the targeted mucosa.
  • the bioadhesive maintains a desired concentration gradient of the biologically active agent into or across the mucosa to ensure penetration of even large molecules (e.g., peptides and proteins) into or through the mucosal epithelium.
  • a bioadhesive within the methods and compositions of the invention yields a two- to five-fold, often a five- to ten-fold increase in permeability for peptides and proteins into or through the mucosal epithelium.
  • This enhancement of epithelial permeation often permits effective transmucosal delivery of large macromolecules, for example to the basal portion of the nasal epithelium or into the adjacent extracellular compartments or a blood plasma or CNS tissue or fluid.
  • bioadhesives are disclosed in the art for oral administration, U.S. Patent Nos. 3,972,995; 4,259,314; 4,680,323; 4,740,365; 4,573,996; 4,292,299; 4,715,369; 4,876,092; 4,855,142; 4,250,163; 4,226,848; 4,948,580; U.S. Patent Reissue No. 33,093, which find use within the novel methods and compositions of the invention.
  • bioadhesive polymers as a mucosal, e.g., nasal, delivery platform within the methods and compositions of the invention can be readily assessed by determining their ability to retain and release glucose-regulating peptide, as well as by their capacity to interact with the mucosal surfaces following incorporation of the active agent therein.
  • well known methods will be applied to determine the biocompatibility of selected polymers with the tissue at the site of mucosal administration.
  • mucus i.e., in the absence of mucolytic or mucus-clearing treatment
  • it can serve as a connecting link to the underlying mucosal epithelium.
  • bioadhesive as used herein also covers mucoadhesive compounds useful for enhancing mucosal delivery of biologically active agents within the invention.
  • adhesive contact to mucosal tissue mediated through adhesion to a mucus gel layer may be limited by incomplete or transient attachment between the mucus layer and the underlying tissue, particularly at nasal surfaces where rapid mucus clearance occurs.
  • mucin glycoproteins are continuously secreted and, immediately after their release from cells or glands, form a viscoelastic gel.
  • the luminal surface of the adherent gel layer is continuously eroded by mechanical, enzymatic and/or ciliary action. Where such activities are more prominent or where longer adhesion times are desired, the coordinate administration methods and combinatorial formulation methods of the invention may further incorporate mucolytic and/or ciliostatic methods or agents as disclosed herein above.
  • mucoadhesive polymers for use within the invention are natural or synthetic macromolecules which adhere to wet mucosal tissue surfaces by complex, but non-specific, mechanisms.
  • the invention also provides methods and compositions incorporating bioadhesives that adhere directly to a cell surface, rather than to mucus, by means of specific, including receptor-mediated, interactions.
  • bioadhesives that function in this specific manner is the group of compounds known as lectins. These are glycoproteins with an ability to specifically recognize and bind to sugar molecules, e.g., glycoproteins or glycolipids, which form part of intranasal epithelial cell membranes and can be considered as "lectin receptors".
  • bioadhesive materials for enhancing intranasal delivery of biologically active agents comprise a matrix of a hydrophilic, e.g., water soluble or swellable, polymer or a mixture of polymers that can adhere to a wet mucous surface.
  • a hydrophilic e.g., water soluble or swellable, polymer or a mixture of polymers that can adhere to a wet mucous surface.
  • These adhesives may be formulated as ointments, hydrogels (see above) thin films, and other application forms. Often, these adhesives have the biologically active agent mixed therewith to effectuate slow release or local delivery of the active agent.
  • Some are formulated with additional ingredients to facilitate penetration of the active agent through the nasal mucosa, e.g., into the circulatory system of the individual.
  • Such 'adhesion by hydration' can be quite strong, but formulations adapted to employ this mechanism must account for swelling which continues as the dosage transforms into a hydrated mucilage. This is projected for many hydrocolloids useful within the invention, especially some cellulose-derivatives, which are generally non-adhesive when applied in pre-hydrated state. Nevertheless, bioadhesive drug delivery systems for mucosal administration are effective within the invention when such materials are applied in the form of a dry polymeric powder, microsphere, or film-type delivery form. Other polymers adhere to mucosal surfaces not only when applied in dry, but also in fully hydrated state, and in the presence of excess amounts of water.
  • a mucoadhesive thus requires due consideration of the conditions, physiological as well as physico-chemical, under which the contact to the tissue will be formed and maintained.
  • the amount of water or humidity usually present at the intended site of adhesion, and the prevailing pH, are known to largely affect the mucoadhesive binding strength of different polymers.
  • the methods and compositions of the invention optionally include the use of carriers, e.g., polymeric delivery vehicles, that function in part to shield the biologically active agent from proteolytic breakdown, while at the same time providing for enhanced penetration of the peptide or protein into or through the nasal mucosa.
  • carriers e.g., polymeric delivery vehicles
  • bioadhesive polymers have demonstrated considerable potential for enhancing oral drug delivery.
  • the bioavailability of 9-desglycinamide, 8-arginine vasopressin (DGAVP) intraduodenally administered to rats together with a 1% (w/v) saline dispersion of the mucoadhesive poly(acrylic acid) derivative polycarbophil is 3-5-fold increased compared to an aqueous solution of the peptide drug without this polymer.
  • Mucoadhesive polymers of the poly(acrylic acid)-type are potent inhibitors of some intestinal proteases.
  • mucoadhesive polymers particularly of the poly(acrylic acid)-type, may serve both as an absorption-promoting adhesive and enzyme-protective agent to enhance controlled delivery of peptide and protein drugs, especially when safety concerns are considered.
  • bioadhesives and other polymeric or non-polymeric absorption-promoting agents for use within the invention may directly increase mucosal permeability to biologically active agents.
  • mucoadhesive polymers and other agents have been postulated to yield enhanced permeation effects beyond what is accounted for by prolonged premucosal residence time of the delivery system.
  • the time course of drug plasma concentrations reportedly suggested that the bioadhesive microspheres caused an acute, but transient increase of insulin permeability across the nasal mucosa.
  • mucoadhesive polymers for use within the invention for example chitosan, reportedly enhance the permeability of certain mucosal epithelia even when they are applied as an aqueous solution or gel.
  • Another mucoadhesive polymer reported to directly affect epithelial permeability is hyaluronic acid and ester derivatives thereof.
  • a particularly useful bioadhesive agent within the coordinate administration, and/or combinatorial formulation methods and compositions of the invention is chitosan, as well as its analogs and derivatives.
  • Chitosan is a non-toxic, biocompatible and biodegradable polymer that is widely used for pharmaceutical and medical applications because of its favorable properties of low toxicity and good biocompatibility. It is a natural polyaminosaccharide prepared from chitin by
  • chitosan increases the retention of glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein at a mucosal site of application. This mode of administration can also improve patient compliance and acceptance.
  • the methods and compositions of the invention will optionally include a novel chitosan derivative or chemically modified form of chitosan.
  • One such novel derivative for use within the invention is denoted as a ⁇ -[l-»4]-2-guanidino-2-deoxy-D-glucose polymer (poly-GuD).
  • Chitosan is the N-deacetylated product of chitin, a naturally occurring polymer that has been used extensively to prepare microspheres for oral and intra-nasal formulations.
  • the chitosan polymer has also been proposed as a soluble carrier for parenteral drug delivery.
  • o-methylisourea is used to convert a chitosan amine to its guanidinium moiety.
  • the guanidinium compound is prepared, for example, by the reaction between equi-normal solutions of chitosan and o-methylisourea atpH above 8.0.
  • Additional compounds classified as bioadhesive agents for use within the present invention act by mediating specific interactions, typically classified as "receptor-ligand interactions" between complementary structures of the bioadhesive compound and a component of the mucosal epithelial surface.
  • lectin-sugar interactions Many natural examples illustrate this form of specific binding bioadhesion, as exemplified by lectin-sugar interactions.
  • Lectins are (glyco) proteins of non-immune origin which bind to polysaccharides or glycoconjugates.
  • Several plant lectins have been investigated as possible pharmaceutical absorption- promoting agents.
  • One plant lectin, Phaseolus vulgaris hemagglutinin (PHA) exhibits high oral bioavailability of more than 10% after feeding to rats.
  • Tomato (Lycopersicon esculeutum) lectin (TL) appears safe for various modes of administration.
  • bioadhesive agents are useful in the combinatorial formulations and coordinate administration methods of the instant invention, which optionally incorporate an effective amount and form of a bioadhesive agent to prolong persistence or otherwise increase mucosal absorption of one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents.
  • the bioadhesive agents may be coordinately administered as adjunct compounds or as additives within the combinatorial formulations of the invention.
  • the bioadhesive agent acts as a 'pharmaceutical glue,' whereas in other embodiments adjunct delivery or combinatorial formulation of the bioadhesive agent serves to intensify contact of the biologically active agent with the nasal mucosa, in some cases by promoting specific receptor-ligand interactions with epithelial cell "receptors," and in others by increasing epithelial permeability to significantly increase the drug concentration gradient measured at a target site of delivery (e.g., liver, blood plasma, or CNS tissue or fluid).
  • a target site of delivery e.g., liver, blood plasma, or CNS tissue or fluid.
  • bioadhesive agents for use within the invention act as enzyme (e.g., protease) inhibitors to enhance the stability of mucosally administered biotherapeutic agents delivered coordinately or in a combinatorial formulation with the bioadhesive agent.
  • enzyme e.g., protease
  • the coordinate administration methods and combinatorial formulations of the instant invention optionally incorporate effective lipid or fatty acid based carriers, processing agents, or delivery vehicles, to provide improved formulations for mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents.
  • formulations and methods are provided for mucosal delivery which comprise one or more of these active agents, such as a peptide or protein, admixed or encapsulated by, or coordinately administered with, a liposome, mixed micellar carrier, or emulsion, to enhance chemical and physical stability and increase the half life of the biologically active agents (e.g., by reducing susceptibility to proteolysis, chemical modification and/or denaturation) upon mucosal delivery.
  • active agents such as a peptide or protein, admixed or encapsulated by, or coordinately administered with, a liposome, mixed micellar carrier, or emulsion
  • specialized delivery systems for biologically active agents comprise small lipid vesicles known as liposomes. These are typically made from natural, biodegradable, non-toxic, and non-immunogenic lipid molecules, and can efficiently entrap or bind drug molecules, including peptides and proteins, into, or onto, their membranes.
  • liposomes are typically made from natural, biodegradable, non-toxic, and non-immunogenic lipid molecules, and can efficiently entrap or bind drug molecules, including peptides and proteins, into, or onto, their membranes.
  • the attractiveness of liposomes as a peptide and protein delivery system within the invention is increased by the fact that the encapsulated proteins can remain in their preferred aqueous environment within the vesicles, while the liposomal membrane protects them against proteolysis and other destabilizing factors.
  • liposome preparation methods known are feasible in the encapsulation of peptides and proteins due to their unique physical and chemical properties, several methods allow the en
  • the biologically active agent is typically entrapped within the liposome, or lipid vesicle, or is bound to the outside of the vesicle.
  • unsaturated long chain fatty acids which also have enhancing activity for mucosal absorption, can form closed vesicles with bilayer-like structures (so called "ufasomes"). These can be formed, for example, using oleic acid to entrap biologically active peptides and proteins for mucosal, e.g., intranasal, delivery within the invention.
  • delivery systems for use within the invention combine the use of polymers and liposomes to ally the advantageous properties of both vehicles such as encapsulation inside the natural polymer fibrin.
  • release of biotherapeutic compounds from this delivery system is controllable through the use of covalent crosslinking and the addition of antifibrinolytic agents to the fibrin polymer.
  • More simplified delivery systems for use within the invention include the use of cationic lipids as delivery vehicles or carriers, which can be effectively employed to provide an electrostatic interaction between the lipid carrier and such charged biologically active agents as proteins and polyanionic nucleic acids. This allows efficient packaging of the drugs into a form suitable for mucosal administration and/or subsequent delivery to systemic compartments.
  • Additional delivery vehicles for use within the invention include long and medium chain fatty acids, as well as surfactant mixed micelles with fatty acids.
  • Most naturally occurring lipids in the form of esters have important implications with regard to their own transport across mucosal surfaces.
  • Free fatty acids and their monoglycerides which have polar groups attached have been demonstrated in the form of mixed micelles to act on the intestinal barrier as penetration enhancers. This discovery of barrier modifying function of free fatty acids (carboxylic acids with a chain length varying from 12 to 20 carbon atoms) and their polar derivatives has stimulated extensive research on the application of these agents as mucosal absorption enhancers.
  • long chain fatty acids especially fusogenic lipids (unsaturated fatty acids and monoglycerides such as oleic acid, linoleic acid, linoleic acid, monoolein, etc.) provide useful carriers to enhance mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein.
  • Medium chain fatty acids (C6 to C 12) and monoglycerides have also been shown to have enhancing activity in intestinal drug absorption and can be adapted for use within the mocosal delivery formulations and methods of the invention.
  • sodium salts of medium and long chain fatty acids are effective delivery vehicles and absorption-enhancing agents for mucosal delivery of biologically active agents within the invention.
  • fatty acids can be employed in soluble forms of sodium salts or by the addition of non-toxic surfactants, e.g., polyoxyethylated hydrogenated castor oil, sodium taurocholate, etc.
  • non-toxic surfactants e.g., polyoxyethylated hydrogenated castor oil, sodium taurocholate, etc.
  • Other fatty acid and mixed micellar preparations that are useful within the invention include, but are not limited to, Na caprylate (C8), Na caprate (ClO), Na laurate (C12) or Na oleate (Cl 8), optionally combined with bile salts, such as glycocholate and taurocholate.
  • Pegylation Additional methods and compositions provided within the invention involve chemical modification of biologically active peptides and proteins by covalent attachment of polymeric materials, for example dextrans, polyvinyl pyrrolidones, glycopeptides, polyethylene glycol and polyamino acids.
  • polymeric materials for example dextrans, polyvinyl pyrrolidones, glycopeptides, polyethylene glycol and polyamino acids.
  • the resulting conjugated peptides and proteins retain their biological activities and solubility for mucosal administration.
  • glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active peptides and proteins are conjugated to polyalkylene oxide polymers, particularly polyethylene glycols (PEG).
  • PEG polyethylene glycols
  • Amine-reactive PEG polymers for use within the invention include SC-PEG with molecular masses of 2000, 5000, 10000, 12000, and 20000; U-PEG-10000; NHS-PEG-3400- biotin; T-PEG-5000; T-PEG-12000; and TPC-PEG-5000.
  • PEGylation of biologically active peptides and proteins may be achieved by modification of carboxyl sites (e.g., aspartic acid or glutamic acid groups in addition to the carboxyl terminus).
  • carboxyl sites e.g., aspartic acid or glutamic acid groups in addition to the carboxyl terminus.
  • the utility of PEG-hydrazide in selective modification of carbodiimide-activated protein carboxyl groups under acidic conditions has been described.
  • bifunctional PEG modification of biologically active peptides and proteins can be employed. In some procedures, charged amino acid residues, including lysine, aspartic acid, and glutamic acid, have a marked
  • biologically active agents such as peptides and proteins for use within the invention can be modified to enhance circulating half-life by shielding the active agent via conjugation to other known protecting or stabilizing compounds, for example by the creation of fusion proteins with an active peptide, protein, analog or mimetic linked to one or more carrier proteins, such as one or more immunoglobulin chains.
  • Mucosal delivery formulations of the present invention comprise glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, typically combined together with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers and, optionally, other therapeutic ingredients.
  • the carrier(s) must be "pharmaceutically acceptable” in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not eliciting an unacceptable deleterious effect in the subject.
  • Such carriers are described herein above or are otherwise well known to those skilled in the art of pharmacology.
  • the formulation should not include substances such as enzymes or oxidizing agents with which the biologically active agent to be administered is known to be incompatible.
  • the formulations may be prepared by any of the methods well known in the art of pharmacy.
  • the glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein may be administered to subjects by a variety of mucosal administration modes, including by oral, rectal, vaginal, intranasal, intrapulmonary, or transdermal delivery, or by topical delivery to the eyes, ears, skin or other mucosal surfaces.
  • glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein can be coordinately or adjunctively administered by non-mucosal routes, including by intramuscular, subcutaneous, intravenous, intra-atrial, intra-articular, intraperitoneal, or parenteral routes.
  • the biologically active agent(s) can be administered ex vivo by direct exposure to cells, tissues or organs originating from a mammalian subject, for example as a component of an ex vivo tissue or organ treatment formulation that contains the biologically active agent in a suitable, liquid or solid carrier.
  • compositions according to the present invention are often administered in an aqueous solution as a nasal or pulmonary spray and may be dispensed in spray form by a variety of methods known to those skilled in the art.
  • Preferred systems for dispensing liquids as a nasal spray are disclosed in U.S. Patent No. 4,511,069.
  • the formulations may be presented in multi- dose containers, for example in the sealed dispensing system disclosed in U.S. Patent No. 4,511,069.
  • Additional aerosol delivery forms may include, e.g., compressed air-, jet-, ultrasonic-, and piezoelectric nebulizers, which deliver the biologically active agent dissolved or suspended in a pharmaceutical solvent, e.g., water, ethanol, or a mixture thereof.
  • Nasal and pulmonary spray solutions of the present invention typically comprise the drug or drug to be delivered, optionally formulated with a surface-active agent, such as a nonionic surfactant (e.g., polysorbate-80), and one or more buffers.
  • a surface-active agent such as a nonionic surfactant (e.g., polysorbate-80)
  • the nasal spray solution further comprises a propellant.
  • the pH of the nasal spray solution is optionally between about pH 7 and 9, preferably 8.5 ⁇ 0.5.
  • Suitable buffers for use within these compositions are as described above or as otherwise known in the art.
  • Other components may be added to enhance or maintain chemical stability, including preservatives, surfactants, dispersants, or gases.
  • Suitable preservatives include, but are not limited to, phenol, methyl paraben, paraben, m-cresol, thiomersal, chlorobutanol, benzylalkonimum chloride, sodium benzoate, and the like.
  • Suitable surfactants include, but are not limited to, oleic acid, sorbitan trioleate, polysorbates, lecithin, phosphotidyl cholines, and various long chain diglycerides and phospholipids.
  • Suitable dispersants include, but are not limited to, ethylenediaminetetraacetic acid, and the like.
  • gases include, but are not limited to, nitrogen, helium, chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs), hydrofluorocarbons (HFCs), carbon dioxide, air, and the like.
  • mucosal formulations are administered as dry powder formulations comprising the biologically active agent in a dry, usually lyophilized, form of an appropriate particle size, or within an appropriate particle size range, for intranasal delivery.
  • Minimum particle size appropriate for deposition within the nasal or pulmonary passages is often about 0.5 ⁇ mass median equivalent aerodynamic diameter (MMEAD), commonly about 1 ⁇ MMEAD, and more typically about 2 ⁇ MMEAD.
  • Maximum particle size appropriate for deposition within the nasal passages is often about 10 ⁇ MMEAD, commonly about 8 ⁇ MMEAD, and more typically about 4 ⁇ MMEAD.
  • Intranasally respirable powders within these size ranges can be produced by a variety of conventional techniques, such as jet milling, spray drying, solvent precipitation, supercritical fluid condensation, and the like.
  • These dry powders of appropriate MMEAD can be administered to a patient via a conventional dry powder inhaler (DPI), which rely on the patient's breath, upon pulmonary or nasal inhalation, to disperse the power into an aerosolized amount.
  • DPI dry powder inhaler
  • the dry powder may be administered via air- assisted devices that use an external power source to disperse the powder into an aerosolized amount, e.g., a piston pump.
  • Dry powder devices typically require a powder mass in the range from about 1 mg to 20 mg to produce a single aerosolized dose ("puff). If the required or desired dose of the biologically active agent is lower than this amount, the powdered active agent will typically be combined with a pharmaceutical dry bulking powder to provide the required total powder mass.
  • Preferred dry bulking powders include sucrose, lactose, dextrose, mannitol, glycine, trehalose, human serum albumin (HSA), and starch.
  • Other suitable dry bulking powders include cellobiose, dextrans, maltotriose, pectin, sodium citrate, sodium ascorbate, and the like.
  • the biologically active agent can be combined with various pharmaceutically acceptable additives, as well as a base or carrier for dispersion of the active agent(s).
  • Desired additives include, but are not limited to, pH control agents, such as arginine, sodium hydroxide, glycine, hydrochloric acid, citric acid, acetic acid, etc.
  • local anesthetics e.g., benzyl alcohol
  • isotonizing agents e.g., sodium chloride, mannitol, sorbitol
  • adsorption inhibitors e.g., Tween 80
  • solubility enhancing agents e.g., cyclodextrins and derivatives thereof
  • stabilizers e.g., serum albumin
  • reducing agents e.g., glutathione
  • the tonicity of the formulation is typically adjusted to a value at which no substantial, irreversible tissue damage will be induced in the nasal mucosa at the site of administration.
  • the tonicity of the solution is adjusted to a value of about 1/3 to 3, more typically 1/2 to 2, and most often 3/4 to 1.7.
  • the biologically active agent may be dispersed in a base or vehicle, which may comprise a hydrophilic compound having a capacity to disperse the active agent and any desired additives.
  • the base may be selected from a wide range of suitable carriers, including but not limited to, copolymers of polycarboxylic acids or salts thereof, carboxylic anhydrides (e.g., maleic anhydride) with other monomers (e.g., methyl (meth)acrylate, acrylic acid, etc.), hydrophilic vinyl polymers such as polyvinyl acetate, polyvinyl alcohol, polyvinylpyrrolidone, cellulose derivatives such as hydroxymethylcellulose, hydroxypropylcellulose, etc., and natural polymers such as chitosan, collagen, sodium alginate, gelatin, hyaluronic acid, and nontoxic metal salts thereof.
  • suitable carriers including but not limited to, copolymers of polycarboxylic acids or salts thereof, carboxylic anhydrides (e.g., male
  • a biodegradable polymer is selected as a base or carrier, for example, polylactic acid, poly(lactic acid-glycolic acid) copolymer, polyhydroxybutyric acid, poly(hydroxybutyric acid-glycolic acid) copolymer and mixtures thereof.
  • synthetic fatty acid esters such as polyglycerin fatty acid esters, sucrose fatty acid esters, etc. can be employed as carriers.
  • Hydrophilic polymers and other carriers can be used alone or in combination, and enhanced structural integrity can be imparted to the carrier by partial crystallization, ionic bonding, crosslinking and the like.
  • the carrier can be provided in a variety of forms, including, fluid or viscous solutions, gels, pastes, powders, microspheres and films for direct application to the nasal mucosa.
  • the use of a selected carrier in this context may result in promotion of absorption of the biologically active agent.
  • the biologically active agent can be combined with the base or carrier according to a variety of methods, and release of the active agent may be by diffusion, disintegration of the carrier, or associated formulation of water channels.
  • the active agent is dispersed in microcapsules (microspheres) or nanocapsules (nanospheres) prepared from a suitable polymer, e.g., isobutyl 2-cyanoacrylate and dispersed in a biocompatible dispersing medium applied to the nasal mucosa, which yields sustained delivery and biological activity over a protracted time.
  • a suitable polymer e.g., isobutyl 2-cyanoacrylate
  • formulations comprising the active agent may also contain a hydrophilic low molecular weight compound as a base or excipient.
  • a hydrophilic low molecular weight compound provides a passage medium through which a water-soluble active agent, such as a physiologically active peptide or protein, may diffuse through the base to the body surface where the active agent is absorbed.
  • the hydrophilic low molecular weight compound optionally absorbs moisture from the mucosa or the administration atmosphere and dissolves the water-soluble active peptide.
  • the molecular weight of the hydrophilic low molecular weight compound is generally not more than 10000 and preferably not more than 3000.
  • hydrophilic low molecular weight compound examples include polyol compounds, such as oligo-, di- and monosaccarides such as sucrose, mannitol, sorbitol, lactose, L-arabinose, D-erythrose, D-ribose, D-xylose, D-mannose, trehalose, D-galactose, lactulose, cellobiose, gentibiose, glycerin and polyethylene glycol.
  • Other examples of hydrophilic low molecular weight compounds useful as carriers within the invention include N-methylpyrrolidone, and alcohols (e.g. oligovinyl alcohol, ethanol, ethylene glycol, propylene glycol, etc.) These hydrophilic low molecular weight compounds can be used alone or in combination with one another or with other active or inactive components of the intranasal formulation.
  • compositions of the invention may alternatively contain as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers substances as required to approximate physiological conditions, such as pH adjusting and buffering agents, tonicity adjusting agents, wetting agents and the like, for example, sodium acetate, sodium lactate, sodium chloride, potassium chloride, calcium chloride, sorbitan monolaurate, triethanolamine oleate, etc.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable carriers include, for example, pharmaceutical grades of mannitol, lactose, starch, magnesium stearate, sodium saccharin, talcum, cellulose, glucose, sucrose, magnesium carbonate, and the like.
  • compositions for administering the biologically active agent can also be formulated as a solution, microemulsion, or other ordered structure suitable for high concentration of active ingredients.
  • the carrier can be a solvent or dispersion medium containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (for example, glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof.
  • Proper fluidity for solutions can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating such as lecithin, by the maintenance of a desired particle size in the case of dispersible formulations, and by the use of surfactants.
  • isotonic agents for example, sugars, polyalcohols such as mannitol, sorbitol, or sodium chloride in the composition.
  • Prolonged absorption of the biologically active agent can be brought about by including in the composition an agent which delays absorption, for example, monostearate salts and gelatin.
  • the biologically active agent is administered in a time-release formulation, for example in a composition which includes a slow release polymer.
  • the active agent can be prepared with carriers that will protect against rapid release, for example a controlled release vehicle such as a polymer, microencapsulated delivery system or bioadhesive gel. Prolonged delivery of the active agent, in various compositions of the invention can be brought about by including in the composition agents that delay absorption, for example, aluminum monosterate hydrogels and gelatin.
  • controlled release binders suitable for use in accordance with the invention include any biocompatible controlled-release material which is inert to the active agent and which is capable of incorporating the biologically active agent.
  • Useful controlled-release binders are materials that are metabolized slowly under physiological conditions following their intranasal delivery (e.g., at the nasal mucosal surface, or in the presence of bodily fluids following transmucosal delivery).
  • Appropriate binders include but are not limited to biocompatible polymers and copolymers previously used in the art in sustained release formulations.
  • biocompatible compounds are non-toxic and inert to surrounding tissues, and do not trigger significant adverse side effects such as nasal irritation, immune response, inflammation, or the like. They are metabolized into metabolic products that are also biocompatible and easily eliminated from the body.
  • Exemplary polymeric materials for use in this context include, but are not limited to, polymeric matrices derived from copolymeric and homopolymeric polyesters having hydrolysable ester linkages. A number of these are known in the art to be biodegradable and to lead to degradation products having no or low toxicity.
  • Exemplary polymers include polyglycolic acids (PGA) and polylactic acids (PLA), poly(DL-lactic acid-co-glycolic acid)(DL PLGA), poly(D-lactic acid-coglycolic acid)(D PLGA) and poly(L-lactic acid-co-glycolic acid)(L PLGA).
  • biodegradable or bioerodable polymers include but are not limited to such polymers as poly(epsilon-caprolactone), poly(epsilon-aprolactone-CO-lactic acid), poly( ⁇ - aprolactone-CO-glycolic acid), poly(beta-hydroxy butyric acid), poly(alkyl-2-cyanoacrilate), hydrogels such as poly(hydroxyethyl methacrylate), polyamides, poly(amino acids) (i.e., L- leucine, glutamic acid, L-aspartic acid and the like), poly (ester urea), poly (2-hydroxyethyl DL- aspartamide), polyacetal polymers, polyorthoesters, polycarbonate, polymaleamides, polysaccharides and copolymers thereof.
  • poly(epsilon-caprolactone) poly(epsilon-aprolactone-CO-lactic acid), poly( ⁇ - aprolactone-CO-g
  • compositions e.g., microcapsules, U.S. Patent Nos. 4,652,441 and 4,917,893, lactic acid-glycolic acid copolymers useful in making microcapsules and other formulations, U.S. Patent Nos. 4,677,191 and 4,728,721, and sustained-release compositions for water-soluble peptides, U.S. Patent No. 4,675,189.
  • Sterile solutions can be prepared by incorporating the active compound in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filtered sterilization.
  • dispersions are prepared by incorporating the active compound into a sterile vehicle that contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above.
  • methods of preparation include vacuum drying and freeze-drying which yields a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof.
  • the prevention of the action of microorganisms can be accomplished by various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, sorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like. Mucosal administration according to the invention allows effective self-administration of treatment by patients, provided that sufficient safeguards are in place to control and monitor dosing and side effects.
  • Mucosal administration also overcomes certain drawbacks of other administration forms, such as injections, that are painful and expose the patient to possible infections and may present drug bioavailability problems.
  • systems for controlled aerosol dispensing of therapeutic liquids as a spray are well known.
  • metered doses of active agent are delivered by means of a specially constructed mechanical pump valve, U.S. Patent No. 4,511,069.
  • the biologically active agent(s) disclosed herein may be administered to the subject in a single bolus delivery, via continuous delivery (e.g., continuous transdermal, mucosal, or intravenous delivery) over an extended time period, or in a repeated administration protocol (e.g., by an hourly, daily or weekly, repeated administration protocol).
  • a therapeutically effective dosage of the glucose-regulating peptide may include repeated doses within a prolonged prophylaxis or treatment regimen that will yield clinically significant results to alleviate one or more symptoms or detectable conditions associated with a targeted disease or condition as set forth above.
  • Determination of effective dosages in this context is typically based on animal model studies followed up by human clinical trials and is guided by determining effective dosages and administration protocols that significantly reduce the occurrence or severity of targeted disease symptoms or conditions in the subject.
  • Suitable models in this regard include, for example, murine, rat, porcine, feline, non- human primate, and other accepted animal model subjects known in the art.
  • effective dosages can be determined using in vitro models (e.g., immunologic and histopathologic assays).
  • the invention provides compositions and methods for intranasal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide, wherein the glucose-regulating peptide compound(s) is/are repeatedly administered through an intranasal effective dosage regimen that involves multiple administrations of the glucose-regulating peptide to the subject during a daily or weekly schedule to maintain a therapeutically effective elevated and lowered pulsatile level of glucose-regulating peptide during an extended dosing period.
  • the compositions and method provide glucose-regulating peptide compound(s) that are self-administered by the subject in a nasal formulation between one and six times daily to maintain a therapeutically effective elevated and lowered pulsatile level of glucose-regulating peptide during an 8-hour to 24-hour extended dosing period.
  • Kits The instant invention also includes kits, packages and multicontainer units containing the above described pharmaceutical compositions, active ingredients, and/or means for administering the same for use in the prevention and treatment of diseases and other conditions in mammalian subjects.
  • these kits include a container or formulation that contains one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs or mimetics, and/or other biologically active agents in combination with mucosal delivery enhancing agents disclosed herein formulated in a pharmaceutical preparation for mucosal delivery.
  • the intranasal formulations of the present invention can be administered using any spray bottle or syringe, or by instillation.
  • An example of a nasal spray bottle is the, "Nasal Spray Pump w/ Safety Clip, Pfeiffer SAP #60548, which delivers a dose of 0.1 mL per squirt and has a diptube length of 36.05 mm. It can be purchased from Pfeiffer of America of Princeton, NJ.
  • Aerosol A product that is packaged under pressure and contains therapeutically active ingredients that are released upon activation of an appropriate valve system.
  • Metered aerosol - A pressurized dosage form comprised of metered dose valves, which allow for the delivery of a uniform quantity of spray upon each activation.
  • Powder aerosol - A product that is packaged under pressure and contains therapeutically active ingredients in the form of a powder, which are released upon activation of an appropriate valve system.
  • Spray aerosol - An aerosol product that utilizes a compressed gas as the propellant to provide the force necessary to expel the product as a wet spray; it generally applicable to solutions of medicinal agents in aqueous solvents.
  • Nasal spray drug products contain therapeutically active ingredients dissolved or suspended in solutions or mixtures of excipients in nonpressurized dispensers.
  • Metered spray - A non-pressurized dosage form consisting of valves that allow the dispensing of a specified quantity of spray upon each activation.
  • Suspension spray - A liquid preparation containing solid particles dispersed in a liquid vehicle and in the form of course droplets or as finely divided solids.
  • Spray characterization is an integral part of the regulatory submissions necessary for Food and Drug Administration (“FDA”) approval of research and development, quality assurance and stability testing procedures for new and existing nasal spray pumps.
  • FDA Food and Drug Administration
  • Thorough characterization of the spray's geometry has been found to be the best indicator of the overall performance of nasal spray pumps.
  • measurements of the spray's divergence angle (plume geometry) as it exits the device; the spray's cross-sectional elliptichy, uniformity and particle/droplet distribution (spray pattern); and the time evolution of the developing spray have been found to be the most representative performance quantities in the characterization of a nasal spray pump.
  • plume geometry and spray pattern measurements are key identifiers for verifying consistency and conformity with the approved data criteria for the nasal spray pumps.
  • Plume Height the measurement from the actuator tip to the point at which the plume angle becomes non-linear because of the breakdown of linear flow. Based on a visual examination of digital images, and to establish a measurement point for width that is consistent with the farthest measurement point of spray pattern, a height of 30 mm is defined for this study
  • Ellipticity Ratio the ratio of the major axis to the minor axis, preferably between 1.0 and 1.5, and most preferably between 1.0 and 1.3.
  • D 1O the diameter of droplet for which 10% of the total liquid volume of sample consists of droplets of a smaller diameter ( ⁇ m)
  • D 50 the diameter of droplet for which 50% of the total liquid volume of sample consists of droplets of a smaller diameter ( ⁇ m), also known as the mass median diameter
  • Span - measurement of the width of the distribution the smaller the value, the narrower the distribution. Span is calculated as: — — . v D50
  • % RSD - percent relative standard deviation the standard deviation divided by the mean of the series and multiplied by 100, also known as % CV.
  • volume- the volume of liquid or powder discharged from the delivery device with each actuation preferably between 0.01 mL and about 2.5 mL and most preferably between 0.02 mL and 0.25 mL.
  • the present example illustrates the reagents, equipment, and the source of each used in the subsequent Examples 1 and 2 of the instant application.
  • Table 1 illustrates the sample reagents used in the subsequent Examples 1 and 2.
  • Table 1 Sample Reagents
  • Table 2 illustrates the source and components of the MatTek EpiAirwayTM System that is described in greater detail in Example 2 of the instant application.
  • Table 3 illustrates the source and components of the LDH assay system described in greater details in Example 2 of the instant application.
  • Table 4 illustrates the instruments and other related laboratory supplies and source of each used herein.
  • Enhancer A Polysorbate 20 (Tween 20)
  • Enhancer B Polysorbate 80 (Tween 80)
  • Enhancer C disodium EDTA
  • Enhancer D Methyl-beta-cyclodextrin (Me- ⁇ -CD)
  • Enhancer E Didecanoylphosphatidyl choline (DDPC)
  • MTT assay was performed on cell culture inserts after TER and LDH samples were taken. % permeation was assessed by two methods, ELISA and HPLC. Basolaterol media samples were divided into five aliquots and stored in 1.5 amber eppendorf tubes. The aliquot needed for LDH assay was stored 2-8°C. The other four aliquots for ELISA and HPLC analysis were stored at - 20 0 C until analysis was performed.
  • M- ⁇ -CD methyl-beta-cyclodextrin
  • EDTA disodium edetate
  • DDPC L- ⁇ - ⁇ hosphatidylcholine didecanoyl
  • BAK Benzalkonium chloride
  • MTT MTT assay
  • LDH LDH assay
  • TER transepithelial electrical resistance
  • the formulations were tested using the in vitro EpiAirway Model System for the transepithelial resistance assay (TER), cell viability assay (MTT), lactate dehydrogenase cell death assay (LDH), and tissue permeation assay. The results were used to determine which formulation achieved the greatest degree of tissue permeation and TER reduction while resulting in no significant cell toxicity.
  • the stability of the formulations was also assayed for pH, appearance, and osmolality changes; peptide content; and peptide purity.
  • the epithelial cells were grown on porous membrane-bottomed cell culture inserts at an air-liquid interface, which results in differentiation of the cells to a highly polarized morphology.
  • the apical surface is ciliated with a microvillous ultrastructure and the epithelium produces mucus (the presence of mucin was confirmed by immunoblotting).
  • the inserts had a diameter of 0.875 cm, providing a surface area of 0.6 cm 2 .
  • the cells were plated onto the inserts at the factory approximately three weeks before shipping.
  • EpiAirway culture membranes were received the day before the experiment started. They were shipped in phenol red and hydrocortisone free medium. Each cell culture insert was placed in a well of a 12 well plate containing 0.5 mL of serum free media (which was warmed to 37°C). The membranes were cultured at 37°C for 24 hrs to allow tissues to equilibrate. The cell culture inserts were refeed with fresh media twice a day until the study began.
  • TER measurements were read using a Tissue Resistance Measurement Chamber connected to an Epithelial Voltohmeter with the electrode leads, both from World Precision Instruments. Background TER was read for each insert on the day the experiment began. After TER was read, 0.5 mL fresh media with 0.05 % Tween was placed in the bottom of each well in a 12-well plate. Inserts were drained on paper towel and placed into the new wells with fresh media, keeping the inserts numbered to correlate with background TER measurements. 50 ul of formulation was added to each insert. Inserts were placed in a shaking incubator at 100 rpm and 37°C for 1 hr.
  • the electrodes and a tissue culture blank insert were equilibrated for at least 20 min in fresh media with the power off prior to checking calibration.
  • the background resistance was measured with 1.5 mL media in the Endohm tissue chamber and 300 ul media in a blank Millicell-CM insert.
  • the top electrode was adjusted so that it was submerged in the media but not making contact with the top surface of the insert membrane. Background resistance of the blank insert was 5-20 ohms.
  • 300 ul media was added to the insert followed by a 20 min incubation at RT before placement in the Endohm chamber to read TER. Resistance was expressed as (resistance measured - blank) x 0.6 cm 2 . All TER values were reported as a function of the surface area of the tissue. TER was calculated as:
  • Ri resistance of the insert with a membrane
  • R b is the resistance of the blank insert
  • A is the area of the membrane (0.6 cm2).
  • the TER values are expressed in %TER, i.e., relative to a control value obtained with PBS in the absence of permeation enhancers or peptide
  • the amount of cyctotoxicity was assayed by measuring the release of LDH from the cells using a CytoTox 96 Cytotoxicity Assay Kit, from Promega Corp. LDH was measured from both apical as well as basolaterol side of inserts. All samples were assayed at the same time. Duplicate samples were performed for the apical and basolaterol samples collected form each cell culture insert in the study. For the basolaterol samples, 50 ⁇ l was loaded, in duplicate, on a 96 well plate. Fresh, cell-free media with 0.05% Tween 20 was used as a blank for all basolaterol samples. Apical samples were centrifuged at 10,000 rpm for 5 min to allow cell debris to settle to the bottle of the tube.
  • MTT assay kit cat # MTT-100 by MatTek Corp. This kit measures the uptake and transformation of tetrazolium salt to its formazan dye (MTT).
  • MTT concentrate was thawed and diluted with media at a ratio of 2 mL MTT: 8 mL media. 300 ⁇ l MTT-media mix was added to each well in a fresh 24-well plate. Tissue culture inserts were gently drained on paper towel and transferred to the MTT containing well, while avoiding trapping bubbles underneath the inserts, and then incubated at 37°C in the dark for a minimum of 3 hours.
  • each insert was removed from the plate, blotted gently (the bottom of the insert on a paper towel) and then immersed in wells of a fresh 24-well plate, each containing 1 mL extractant solution. The plate was then be covered and placed on shaker for 1 hr. After the 1 hr period, the liquid in each insert was decanted back into the well from which it was taken, and the insert was discarded. 50 ⁇ l of the extractant solution from each well was pipetted in triplicate into a 96 well plate and diluted with the addition of 150 ⁇ l of fresh extractant solution. Extract blanks were included in triplicate. The optical density of the samples was measured at 550 nm on a Molecular Devices optical density plate reader using Soft Maxpro). The MTT values are expressed in %MTT, i.e., relative to a control value obtained with
  • ELISA was used to quantitate the amount of liraglutide that permeated across the apical to the basolateral side of the insert.
  • the loading volume was 100 ⁇ L per insert and the permeation sampling time was
  • Enhancer A and B showed little to no reduction in TER as well, indicating that these excipients did not affect the tight junction (TJ) in the presence of liraglutide.
  • Enhancer C disodium EDTA (EDTA), showed significant TER reduction. The lowest concentration of EDTA tested, 1 mg/mL, showed 80% TER reduction whereas 10 and 25 mg/mL (mid and high cone.) resulted in 100% reduction in TER.
  • Enhancer D methyl-beta- cyclodextrin (M- ⁇ -CD), at 45 mg/mL (Dl) showed some effect in reducing TER.
  • Enhancer E DDPC (L- ⁇ -phosphatidylcholine didecanoyl), was not tested by itself because of its low CMC and low aqueous solubility.
  • Formulation containing all low concentration of EDTA (Cl, 1 mg/mL), Me- ⁇ -CD (Dl, 45 mg/mL) and DDPC (El, 1 mg/mL) resulted in a large but not complete reduction in TER reduction similar to mid-to-high concentrations of EDTA.
  • the formulations that completely reduced TER after a one-hour incubation period were those that contained at least 10 mg/mL EDTA.
  • Liraglutide in PBS alone showed no permeatility in vitro. TER was unchanged after 1 hour incubation period. Addition of Tween 20 or 80 did not enhance permeation or decrease % TER at the concentrations tested in this study (0-1%). The addition of EDTA increased % permeation and decreased % TER. There was a trend that as the concentration of EDTA increased the % permeation of liraglutide also increased. Liraglutide in the presence of 25 mg/mL ETDA resulted in 8.3 ⁇ 2.4 % permeation. Permeation improved when in combinations of EDTA and Me- ⁇ -CD, or EDTA, Me- ⁇ -CD and DDPC. All tested formulations remained clear and colorless and showed high protein recovery after 15 days storage at 25 0 C, indicating good 15 day stability at room temperature.
  • the second in vitro screening study focused on three enhancers: EDTA, Me- ⁇ -CD, and DPPC.
  • the second screening round tested formulations containing the three permeation enhancers at various levels individually or in combination.
  • formulation stability at the liraglutide concentration of 5 mg/mL in the presence of permeation enhancers was evaluated.
  • Preservatives were also investigated for effects on % permeation, % TER, % MTT, % LDH, and stability. All formulations tested contained 5 mg/mL liraglutide and 8 mM phosphate, pH 8.0.
  • the basolateral media contained 1% BSA to prevent adsorption. Formulations were stored at 37 0 C for 7 days and analyzed for peptide recovery.
  • M- ⁇ -CD methyl-beta-cyclodextrin
  • EDTA disodium edetate
  • DDPC L- ⁇ -phosphatidylcholi ⁇ e didecanoyl
  • BAK benzalkonium chloride
  • CB Chorobutanol
  • MP sodium methyl paraben
  • PP sodium propyl paraben
  • EtOH Ethanol
  • MTT MTT assay
  • LDH LDH assay
  • TER transepithelial electrical resistance
  • Formulations containing EDTA and Me- ⁇ -CD enhancers resulted in high % MTT, low % LDH, and enhanced permeation of peptide.
  • a surface response 3D plot showing the effect of EDTA and Me- ⁇ -CD is shown in Figure 1.
  • Table 11 Formulation Appearance After 1-Wk and 15-Days Storage at 37 0 C
  • a variety of potential stabilizers such as sugars, polymers, amino acids, lipids, and surfactants were evaluated (see Table 14).
  • Phosphate buffer was not added to any of the formulations.
  • the formulation pH was increased from 8.0 to 8.5-8.7 by addition of NaOH.
  • Physical stability was measured at 37°C.
  • the compositions of formulations that were evaluated are listed in Table 14. The physical stability of the formulations was monitored by visual inspection of the solutions at the time of manufacturing and after 2-wk storage at 37°C.
  • BAK Benzalkonium chloride
  • HMPC hydroxypropyl methylcellulose
  • EtOH ethanol
  • PEG Poly(ethylene glycol) All the formulations were prepared by adding the listed amount of each ingredient from stock solutions or powders as specified in Table 15. The formulations were mixed by gentle inversion. Initial testing included pH, osmolality and appearance followed by storage at 37°C accelerated temperature. The chemicals used are listed in Table 15.
  • EDTA/Me- ⁇ -CD formulations at various concentrations without phosphate present or any additional stabilizers were clear and colorless after 2 weeks at 37°C (#10, #11, #12, #36, #37, and #38). Additional stabilizers added to the EDTA/Me- ⁇ -CD formulations that remained clear and colorless included the following: 75 mM arg (#2, #9, #13, #39), 75 mM leu (#3.
  • Table 20 shows the permeation data collected for 50 mg/mL liraglutide formulations containing EDTA as the permeation enhancer. Average permeation for these formulations was 10-15%. The permeation data for the remaining formulations are also shown in Table 20. All of the formulations showed ⁇ 10-25% permeation. The results showed that M- ⁇ -CD subtantially improved permeation in combination with EDTA and DDPC.
  • the formulations were placed on real time (5 0 C) and accelerated stability (25 0 C and 37 0 C) and tested on the in vitro cell model. Each formulation was manufactured at two liraglutide concentrations of 5 and 50 mg/mL to study the effect of liraglutide concentration on the in vitro permeation. The formulation containing mannitol as the only excipient was the control for the in vitro experiment.
  • the main permeation enhancers for the liraglutide formulations are 10 mg/mL EDTA alone or 10 mg/mL EDTA/45 mg/mL Me- ⁇ -CD combination.
  • Table 22 shows the appearance for the formulations containing 50 mg/mL liraglutide with 10 mg/mL EDTA as the permeation enhancer after 14 and 21 days of storage at 37 0 C. All formulations remained physically stable. Table 23 summarizes the appearance of all 50 mg/mL liraglutide formulations with EDTA/cyclodextrin as the permeation enhancers after 14 and 21 days of storage at 37 0 C. Three formulations remained physical stable at pH 8.5 up to 21-day storage at 37 0 C.
  • the enhancer/stabilizer combinations were 1) 10 mg/ mL EDTA and 32 mg/mL ⁇ -CD; 2) 10 mg/ mL EDTA, 45 mg/mL Me- ⁇ -CD and 1 mg/mL DDPC; or 3) 10 mg/ mL EDTA, 45 mg/mL M- ⁇ -CD, 1 mg/mL DDPC and 75 mM leucine.
  • DDPC acted as a stabilizer for liraglutide formulations. Unexpected physically instability was noted for the formulation containing 50 mg/mL liraglutide, 10 mg/ml EDTA, 45 mg/mL Me- ⁇ -CD and 75 mM leucine.
  • Table 28 Physical Stability of 50 mg/mL Liraglutide after 29 Days of Storage at 37 0 C
  • Table 30 Physical Stability of 5 and 50 mg/mL Liraglutide After 14 Days of Storage at 25 0 C
  • the PK results from Rabbit PK study 1 are shown in Figure 2.
  • the PK results showed that formulations 4, 5, and 7 had increased bioavailablity compared to the formulation without enhancers (Fl).
  • Two additional Rabbit PK studies were conducted.
  • the formulations containing liraglutide were tested in Rabbit PK Study 2 and 3 (See Table 33).
  • the dose response for nasal liraglutide formulations is shown in Figure 3.
  • the results of Rabbit PK Study 2 are showed some degree of dose proportionality.
  • Rabbit PK Study 3 evaluated the effect of increasing enhancer concentrations based on
  • the results of this study are shown in Figure 4.
  • the Rabbit Study 3 data is compared to 20 mg/mL (10, 45, 1) data from Rabbit PK Study 2.
  • the results showed enhanced PK with increased M- ⁇ -CD (90 mg/mL).
  • the highest bioavailablity was shown with the Study 3-2 formulation (10, 90, 5).
  • the PK profiles of liraglutide show a surprising departure from that obtained with intranasal native GLP-I in that the elevated plasma levels are prolonged with the derivative molecule. The basis for the prolonged PK profile was investigated.
  • Dosing of liraglutide for intranasal administration was calculated relative to a subcutaneous (SQ) dosage.
  • SQ subcutaneous
  • a bioavailability after SQ administration of approximately 55% results in a systemic dose of approximately 700 ⁇ g.
  • the results suggest that approximately 50 mg/ml liraglutide may provide an effective single systemic dose for humans.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Diabetes (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Endocrinology (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Emergency Medicine (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
  • Otolaryngology (AREA)
  • Inorganic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Zoology (AREA)
  • Gastroenterology & Hepatology (AREA)
  • Obesity (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Medicinal Preparation (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)

Abstract

What is described is an aqueous pharmaceutical formulation for intranasal delivery of liraglutide, comprising liraglutide, a solubilizing agent, and a chelating agent; a dosage form comprising the formulation; and a method of using such formulation for treating metabolic diseases in a mammal. Also described is a method for treating metabolic diseases in a mammal comprising administering intranasally a liraglutide formulation comprises a therapeutically effective amount of liraglutide and one or more excipients selected from the group consisting of a solubilizing agent and a chelating agent.

Description

PHARMACEUTICAL FORMULATIONS OF GLP-I DERIVATIVES
BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
Glucose-regulating peptides (GRP) are a class of peptides that have therapeutic potential in the treatment of insulin dependent diabetes mellitus (IDDM), gestational diabetes or non insulin-dependent diabetes mellitus (NIDDM), the treatment of obesity and the treatment of dyslipidemia. See U.S. Patent No. 6,506,724; U.S. Patent Application Publication
No. 20030036504A1; European Patent No. EP1083924B1; International Patent Application Publication No. WO 98/3023 IAl; and International Patent Application No. WO 00/73331A2. These GRPs include glucagons-like peptide (GLP), e.g., GLP-I, GLP-I derivatives, the exendins, especially exendin-4, also known as exenatide, and amylin peptides and amylin analogs such as pramlintide. However, to date these peptides have only been administered to humans by injection.
A major disadvantage of drug administration by injection is that trained personnel are often required to administer the drug. Additionally, trained personnel are put in harms way when administering a drug by injection. For self-administered drugs, many patients are reluctant or unable to give themselves injections on a regular basis. Injection is also associated with increased risks of infection. Other disadvantages of drug injection include variability of delivery results between individuals, as well as unpredictable intensity and duration of drug action.
Oral administration is available as an alternative; however, certain therapeutic agents exhibit very low bioavailability and considerable time delay in action when given by this route due to hepatic first-pass metabolism and degradation in the gastrointestinal tract. Thus, there is a need to develop modes of administration for GLPs other than by injection and/or oral administration.
Mucosal administration of therapeutic compounds offers certain advantages over injection and other modes of administration, for example convenience and speed of delivery, as well as reducing or eliminating compliance problems and side effects that attend delivery.
However, mucosal delivery of biologically active agents is limited by mucosal barrier functions and other factors. Epithelial cells make up the mucosal barrier and provide a crucial interface between the external environment and mucosal and submucosal tissues and extracellular compartments. One of the most important functions of mucosal epithelial cells is to determine and regulate mucosal permeability. In this context, epithelial cells create selective permeability barriers between different physiological compartments. Selective permeability is the result of regulated transport of molecules through the cytoplasm (the transcellular pathway) and the regulated permeability of the spaces between the cells (the paracellular pathway). Intercellular junctions between epithelial cells are known to be involved in both the maintenance and regulation of the epithelial barrier function, and cell-cell adhesion. Tight junctions (TJ) of epithelial and endothelial cells are particularly important for cell-cell junctions that regulate permeability of the paracellular pathway, and also divide the cell surface into apical and basolateral compartments. Tight junctions form continuous circumferential intercellular contacts between epithelial cells and create a regulated barrier to the paracellular movement of water, solutes, and immune cells. They also provide a second type of barrier that contributes to cell polarity by limiting exchange of membrane lipids between the apical and basolateral membrane domains.
In the context of drug delivery, the ability of drugs to permeate epithelial cell layers of mucosal surfaces, unassisted by delivery-enhancing agents, appears to be related to a number of factors, including molecular size, lipid solubility, and ionization. In general, small molecules, less than about 300-1,000 daltons, are often capable of penetrating mucosal barriers, however, as molecular size increases, permeability decreases rapidly. For these reasons, mucosal drug administration typically requires larger amounts of drug than administration by injection. Other therapeutic compounds, including large molecule drugs, are often refractory to mucosal delivery. In addition to poor intrinsic permeability, large macromolecular drugs are often subject to limited diffusion, as well as lumenal and cellular enzymatic degradation and rapid clearance at mucosal sites. Thus, in order to deliver these larger molecules in therapeutically effective amounts, cell permeation enhancing agents are required to aid their passage across these mucosal surfaces and into systemic circulation where they may quickly act on the target tissue.
The half life of liraglutide (NN2211), a potent, long-acting, once-daily GLP-I analog, is about 12 hours via subcutaneous administration whereas the half life of GLP-I is about half an hour. (Birgitte, et al., J. CHn. Pharmacol 46:635-641, 2006; Jundsen, et al., J. Med. Chem. 43: 1664-1669, 2000; and Agerso, et al., Diabetologia 45:195-202, 2002. Treatment with up to 0.75 mg injectable liraglutide once daily in patients with type H diabetes showed improved glycemic control while body weight remained stable. (Madsbad, et al., Diabetes Care 27:1335-1342, 2004; Feinglos, et al., Diabet. Med. 22:1016-1023, 2005). The increase in half life is achieved by modification of the chemical structure of GLP-I to enable binding to albumin in circulating blood and thereby avoiding rapid digestion by dipeptidyl peptidase IV. The structure modification of liraglutide has a arginine substitution at Lys(34) and a fatty acid (C16) attached to Lys(26). There is -1% of unbound liraglutide dosed due to its high affinity to albumin and thus liraglutide requires a high dose to achieve the pharmacological effect. There is a need for developing a stable high concentration intranasal GLP-I analog formulation for use in the treatment of human disease including obesity and diabetes. BRIEF DISCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
Figure 1. 3D plot showing the effect of EDTA and Me-β-CD. Figure 2. PK data in rabbits with EDTA/Me-β-CD/DDPC intranasal formulations (Study 1).
Figure 3. PK data in rabbits with 10, 20, 30, 40, and 50 mg/ml Liraglutide (Study 2). Figure 4. PK data in rabbits with alternative excipient concentrations (Study 3).
Figure 5. Pulse chase in rabbits with Study 2-5 excipients.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF INVENTION
The present invention fulfills foregoing needs and satisfies additional objects and advantages by providing novel, effective methods and compositions for mucosal, especially intranasal, delivery of a glucose-regulating peptide analogs, such as liraglutide, to treat diabetes mellitus, hyperglycemia, obesity, induce satiety in an individual and to promote weight-loss in an individual.
In exemplary embodiments, the enhanced delivery methods and compositions of the present invention provide for therapeutically effective mucosal delivery of the glucose-regulating peptide agonist for prevention or treatment of metabolic diseases such as obesity and eating disorders in mammalian subjects. In one aspect of the invention, pharmaceutical formulations suitable for intranasal administration are provided that comprise a therapeutically effective amount of a glucose-regulating peptide and one or more intranasal delivery-enhancing agents as described herein, which formulations are effective in a nasal mucosal delivery method of the invention to prevent the onset or progression of obesity or eating disorders in a mammalian subject. Nasal mucosal delivery of a therapeutically effective amount of a glucose-regulating peptide agonist and one or more intranasal delivery-enhancing agents yields elevated therapeutic levels of the glucose-regulating peptide agonist in the subject.
The enhanced delivery methods and compositions of the present invention provide for therapeutically effective mucosal delivery of a glucose-regulating peptide for prevention or treatment of a variety of diseases and conditions in mammalian subjects. Glucose-regulating peptide can be administered via a variety of mucosal routes, for example by contacting the glucose-regulating peptide to a nasal mucosal epithelium, a bronchial or pulmonary mucosal epithelium, the oral buccal surface or the oral and small intestinal mucosal surface. In exemplary embodiments, the methods and compositions are directed to or formulated for intranasal delivery (e.g., nasal mucosal delivery or intranasal mucosal delivery).
The foregoing mucosal glucose-regulating peptide formulations and preparative and delivery methods of the invention provide improved mucosal delivery of a glucose-regulating peptide to mammalian subjects. These compositions and methods can involve combinatorial formulation or coordinate administration of one or more glucose-regulating peptides with one or more mucosal delivery-enhancing agents. Among the mucosal delivery-enhancing agents to be selected from to achieve these formulations and methods are (A) solubilization agents; (B) charge modifying agents; (C) pH control agents; (D) degradative enzyme inhibitors; (E) mucolytic or mucus clearing agents; (F) ciliostatic agents; (G) membrane penetration-enhancing agents (e.g., (i) a surfactant; (ii) a bile salt; (iii) a phospholipid or fatty acid additive, mixed micelle, liposome, or carrier; (iv) an alcohol; (v) an enamine; (vi) a NO donor compound; (vii) a long-chain amphipathic molecule; (viii) a small hydrophobic penetration enhancer; (ix) sodium or a salicylic acid derivative; (x) a glycerol ester of acetoacetic acid; (xi) a cyclodextrin or beta-cyclodextrin derivative; (xii) a medium-chain fatty acid; (xiii) a chelating agent; (xiv) an amino acid or salt thereof; (xv) an N-acetylamino acid or salt thereof; (xvi) an enzyme degradative to a selected membrane component; (xvii) an inhibitor of fatty acid synthesis; (xviii) an inhibitor of cholesterol synthesis; or (xiv) any combination of the membrane penetration enhancing agents of (i)-(xviii)); (H) modulatory agents of epithelial junction physiology, such as nitric oxide (NO) stimulators, chitosan, and chitosan derivatives;
(I) vasodilator agents; (J) selective transport-enhancing agents; and (K) stabilizing delivery vehicles, carriers, supports or complex-forming species with which the glucose-regulating peptide (s) is/are effectively combined, associated, contained, encapsulated or bound to stabilize the active agent for enhanced mucosal delivery. In various embodiments of the invention, a glucose-regulating peptide is combined with one, two, three, four or more of the mucosal delivery-enhancing agents recited in (A)-(K) above. These mucosal delivery-enhancing agents may be admixed, alone or together, with the glucose- regulating peptide, or otherwise combined therewith in a pharmaceutically acceptable formulation or delivery vehicle. Formulation of a glucose-regulating peptide with one or more of the mucosal delivery-enhancing agents according to the teachings herein (optionally including any combination of two or more mucosal delivery-enhancing agents selected from (A)-(K) above) provides for increased bioavailability of the glucose-regulating binding peptide following delivery thereof to a mucosal surface of a mammalian subject.
Thus, the present invention is a method for suppressing appetite, promoting weight loss, decreasing food intake, or treating obesity and/or diabetes in a mammal comprising transmucosally administering a formulation comprised of a glucose-regulating peptide.
The present invention further provides for the use of a glucose-regulating peptide for the production of medicament for the transmucosal, administration of a glucose-regulating peptide for treating hyperglycemia, diabetes mellitus, metabolic syndrome, dyslipidemia, suppressing appetite, promoting weight loss, decreasing food intake, or treating obesity in a mammal.
A mucosally effective dose of glucose-regulating peptide within the pharmaceutical formulations of the present invention comprises, for example, between about a 1.25 to 1.9 mg dosage per day. The pharmaceutical formulations of the present invention may be administered one or more times per day, or 3 times per week or once per week for between one week and at least 96 weeks or even for the life of the individual patient or subject. In certain embodiments, the pharmaceutical formulations of the invention are administered one or more times daily, two times daily, four times daily, six times daily, or eight times daily.
Intranasal delivery-enhancing agents are employed which enhance delivery of a glucose- regulating peptide into or across a nasal mucosal surface. For passively absorbed drugs, the relative contribution of paracellular and transcellular pathways to drug transport depends upon the pKa, partition coefficient, molecular radius and charge of the drug, the pH of the luminal environment in which the drug is delivered, and the area of the absorbing surface. The intranasal delivery-enhancing agent of the present invention may be a pH control agent. The pH of the pharmaceutical formulation of the present invention is a factor affecting absorption of amylin via paracellular and transcellular pathways to drug transport. In one embodiment, the pharmaceutical formulation of the present invention is pH adjusted to between about pH 7 to 9. Generally, the pH is about 8.5 ± 0.5.
As noted above, the present invention provides improved methods and compositions for mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide to mammalian subjects for treatment or prevention of a variety of diseases and conditions. Examples of appropriate mammalian subjects for treatment and prophylaxis according to the methods of the invention include, but are not restricted to, humans and non-human primates, livestock species, such as horses, cattle, sheep, and goats, and research and domestic species, including dogs, cats, mice, rats, guinea pigs, and rabbits.
In order to provide better understanding of the present invention, the following definitions are provided:
Glucagon-like Peptides TGLP)
The amino acid sequence of GLP-I is given Le., by Schmidt, et al., Diabetologia 25:704-707, 1985. Human GLP-I is a 37 amino acid residue peptide originating from preproglucagon which is synthesized, i.e., in the L-cells in the distal ileum, in the pancreas and in the brain. Processing of preproglucagon to GLP-I (7-36)amide, GLP-l(7-37) and GLP-2 occurs mainly in the L-cells. Although the interesting pharmacological properties of GLP-l(7-37) and analogues thereof have attracted much attention in recent years only little is known about the structure of these molecules. The secondary structure of GLP-I in micelles has been described by Thorton, et al, Biochemistry 33:3532-3539, 1994, but in normal solution, GLP-I is considered a very flexible molecule.
GLP-I and analogues of GLP-I and fragments thereof are useful i.e., in the treatment of Type 1 and Type 2 diabetes and obesity. GLP-I analogues, GLP-I fragments and functional derivatives of GLP-I described in Hoist, J., Expert Opin. Emerg. Drugs P(l):155-161, 2004; Rolin, R., et al., Am. J. Physiol. Endocrinol. Metab. 283-.Ε745-Ε752 (2002); Deacon C, Diabetes 53:2181-2187 (2004); Perry, T., et al., Trends Pharmacol Sci. 24(7):377-383, 2003; HoIz, G., et al., Curr. Med. Chem. 10(22): 2471-2481, 2003; Naslund, E., et al., Regul. Pept. 106:89-95, 2002; patent applications WO 87/06941 ; WO 90/11296; WO 91/11457; patents EP 0708179-A2 and EP 0699686-A2 are incorporated by reference herein in their entirety:
WO 87/06941 discloses GLP-I fragments, including GLP- 1(7-37), and functional derivatives thereof and to their use as an insulinotropic agent.
WO 90/11296 discloses GLP-I fragments, including GLP-l(7-36), and functional derivatives thereof which have an insulinotropic activity which exceeds the insulinotropic activity of GLP-l(l-36) or GLP-l(l-37) and to their use as insulinotropic agents.
WO 91/11457 discloses analogues of the active GLP-I peptides 7-34, 7-35, 7-36, and 7-37 which can also be useful as GLP-I moieties.
EP 0708179-A2 (Eli Lilly & Co.) discloses GLP-I analogues and derivatives that include an N-terminal imidazole group and optionally an unbranched Ce -Cio acyl group in attached to the lysine residue in position 34.
EP 0699686-A2 (Eli Lilly & Co.) discloses certain N-terminal truncated fragments of GLP-I that are reported to be biologically active.
The amino acid sequence of GLP-I (1-37) is: HDEFERHAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRG (SEQ ID NO: 1)
The amino acid sequence of GLP-l(7-37) is: HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRG (SEQ ID NO: 2)
The amino acid sequence of GLP-I (7-36) is: HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGR (SEQ ID NO: 3) The amino acid sequence of GLP-I (7-34) is:
HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVK (SEQ ID NO 4).
The amino acid sequence of GLP-I (9-36) is: EGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGR (SEQ ID NO: 5)
The GLP-I analogs listed below have enhanced DPP-IV resistance. The amino acid sequence of the GLP-I analog GG is:
HGEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGR (SEQ ID NO: 6).
The amino acid sequence of the GLP-I analog GG1 is: HGEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRPSS (SEQ ID NO: 7).
The amino acid sequence of the GLP-I analog GG2 is: HGEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRPSSGAP (SEQ ID NO: 8).
The amino acid sequence of the GLP-I analog GG3 is: HGEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRPSSGAPPPS (SEQ ID NO: 9).
The amino acid sequence of the GLP-I analog GLP-I ET is: HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGGPSSGAPPPS (SEQ ID NO: 10). The amino acid sequence of the GLP-I synthetic analog NN2211 (liraglutide) is:
HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAK*EFIA WLVRGRG (SEQ ID NO: 11) where K* at position 26 of the amino acid chain is modified by acylation to generate a hexadecanoyl side chain (Le., K-JV1S- (γ-Glu (7V-α-hexadecanoyl).
The amino acid sequence of the GLP-I synthetic analog CJC-1131 is: HA*EGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAKEFIAWLVKGRK* (SEQ ID NO: 12) where A* at position 8 of the amino acid chain is a D-alanine substituted for a L-alanine and the K* at position 37 of the amino acid chain has a [2-[2-[2-maleimidopropionamido(ethoxy)ethoxy]acetamide linker at its ε amino group.
The amino acid sequence of the GLP-I synthetic analog LY315902 is: des- HAEGTFTSDVSSYLEGQAAREFIAWLVK*GRG (SEQ ID NO: 13) where the histidine residue at the N-terminus (des-H) does not contain an amino group and the K* at position 34 is modified by acylation to generate a octanoyl side chain (i.e., K-(octoanoyl)).
Mucosal Delivery Enhancing Agents
"Mucosal delivery enhancing agents" are defined as chemicals and other excipients that, when added to a formulation comprising water, salts and/or common buffers and glucose-regulating peptide (the control formulation) produce a formulation that produces a significant increase in transport of glucose-regulating peptide across a mucosa as measured by the maximum blood, serum, or cerebral spinal fluid concentration (Cmax) or by the area under the curve, AUC, in a plot of concentration versus time. A mucosa includes the nasal, oral, intestinal, buccal, bronchopulmonary, vaginal, and rectal mucosal surfaces and in fact includes all mucus- secreting membranes lining all body cavities or passages that communicate with the exterior. Mucosal delivery enhancing agents are sometimes called carriers. Endotoxin-free Formulation
"Endotoxin-free formulation" means a formulation which contains a glucose-regulating peptide and one or more mucosal delivery enhancing agents that is substantially free of endotoxins and/or related pyrogenic substances. Endotoxins include toxins that are confined inside a microorganism and are released only when the microorganisms are broken down or die. Pyrogenic substances include fever-inducing, thermostable substances (glycoproteins) from the outer membrane of bacteria and other microorganisms. Both of these substances can cause fever, hypotension and shock if administered to humans. Producing formulations that are endotoxin- free can require special equipment, expert artisans, and can be significantly more expensive than making formulations that are not endotoxin-free. Because intravenous administration of GLP or amylin simultaneously with infusion of endotoxin in rodents has been shown to prevent the hypotension and even death associated with the administration of endotoxin alone (U.S. Patent No. 4,839,343), producing endotoxin-free formulations of these therapeutic agents would not be expected to be necessary for non-parental (non-injected) administration.
Non-Infused Administration "Non-infused administration" means any method of delivery that does not involve an injection directly into an artery or vein, a method which forces or drives (typically a fluid) into something and especially to introduce into a body part by means of a needle, syringe or other invasive method. Non-infused administration includes subcutaneous injection, intramuscular injection, intraparitoneal injection and the non-injection methods of delivery to a mucosa.
Methods and Compositions of Delivery
Improved methods and compositions for mucosal administration of glucose-regulating peptide to mammalian subjects optimize glucose-regulating peptide dosing schedules. The present invention provides mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide formulated with one or more mucosal delivery-enhancing agents wherein glucose-regulating peptide dosage release is substantially normalized and/or sustained for an effective delivery period of glucose-regulating peptide release ranges from approximately 0.1 to 2.0 hours; 0.4 to 1.5 hours; 0.7 to 1.5 hours; or 0.8 to 1.0 hours; following mucosal administration. The sustained release of glucose-regulating peptide achieved may be facilitated by repeated administration of exogenous glucose-regulating peptide utilizing methods and compositions of the present invention.
Compositions and Methods of Sustained Release
Improved compositions and methods for mucosal administration of glucose-regulating peptide to mammalian subjects optimize glucose-regulating peptide dosing schedules. The present invention provides improved mucosal (e.g., nasal) delivery of a formulation comprising glucose-regulating peptide in combination with one or more mucosal delivery-enhancing agents and an optional sustained release-enhancing agent or agents. Mucosal delivery-enhancing agents of the present invention yield an effective increase in delivery, e.g., an increase in the maximal plasma concentration (Cmax) to enhance the therapeutic activity of mucosally-administered glucose-regulating peptide. A second factor affecting therapeutic activity of glucose-regulating peptide in the blood plasma and CNS is residence time (RT). Sustained release-enhancing agents, in combination with intranasal delivery-enhancing agents, increase Cmax and increase residence time (RT) of glucose-regulating peptide. Polymeric delivery vehicles and other agents and methods of the present invention that yield sustained release-enhancing formulations, for example, polyethylene glycol (PEG), are disclosed herein. The present invention provides an improved glucose-regulating peptide delivery method and dosage form for treatment of symptoms related to obesity, diabetes, hyperglycemia, metabolic syndrome, coronary syndrome, colon cancer, exendin cancer, breast cancer, myocardial infraction, promoting neurogenesis, suppressing appetite, promoting weight loss, and decreasing food intake in mammalian subjects. Within the mucosal delivery formulations and methods of the invention, the glucose-regulating peptide is frequently combined or coordinately administered with a suitable carrier or vehicle for mucosal delivery. As used herein, the term "carrier" means pharmaceutically acceptable solid or liquid filler, diluent or encapsulating material. A water-containing liquid carrier can contain pharmaceutically acceptable additives such as acidifying agents, alkalizing agents, antimicrobial preservatives, antioxidants, buffering agents, chelating agents, complexing agents, solubilizing agents, humectants, solvents, suspending and/or viscosity-increasing agents, tonicity agents, wetting agents or other biocompatible materials. A tabulation of ingredients listed by the above categories can be found in the U.S. Pharmacopeia National Formulary, 1857-1859, 1990. Some examples of the materials which can serve as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers are sugars, such as lactose, glucose and sucrose; starches such as corn starch and potato starch; cellulose and its derivatives such as sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; powdered tragacanth; malt; gelatin; talc; excipients such as cocoa butter and suppository waxes; oils such as peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil and soybean oil; glycols, such as propylene glycol; polyols such as glycerin, sorbitol, mannitol and polyethylene glycol; esters such as ethyl oleate and ethyl laurate; agar; buffering agents such as magnesium hydroxide and aluminum hydroxide; alginic acid; pyrogen free water; isotonic saline; Ringer's solution, ethyl alcohol and phosphate buffer solutions, as well as other non toxic compatible substances used in pharmaceutical formulations. Wetting agents, emulsifiers and lubricants such as sodium lauryl sulfate and magnesium stearate, as well as coloring agents, release agents, coating agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents, preservatives and antioxidants can also be present in the compositions, according to the desires of the formulator. Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable antioxidants include water soluble antioxidants such as ascorbic acid, cysteine hydrochloride, sodium bisulfite, sodium metabisulfite, sodium sulfite and the like; oil-soluble antioxidants such as ascorbyl palmitate, butylated hydroxyanisole (BHA), butylated hydroxytoluene (BHT), lecithin, propyl gallate, alpha-tocopherol and the like; and metal- chelating agents such as citric acid, ethylenediamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA), sorbitol, tartaric acid, phosphoric acid and the like. The amount of active ingredient that can be combined with the carrier materials to produce a single dosage form will vary depending upon the particular mode of administration.
Within the mucosal delivery compositions and methods of the invention, various delivery-enhancing agents are employed which enhance delivery of glucose-regulating peptide into or across a mucosal surface. In this regard, delivery of glucose-regulating peptide across the mucosal epithelium can occur "transcellularly" or "paracellularly." The extent to which these pathways contribute to the overall flux and bioavailability of the glucose-regulating peptide depends upon the environment of the mucosa, the physico-chemical properties the active agent, and the properties of the mucosal epithelium. Paracellular transport involves only passive diffusion, whereas transcellular transport can occur by passive, facilitated or active processes. Generally, hydrophilic, passively transported, polar solutes diffuse through the paracellular route, while more lipophilic solutes use the transcellular route. Absorption and bioavailability (e.g., as reflected by a permeability coefficient or physiological assay), for diverse, passively and actively absorbed solutes, can be readily evaluated, in terms of both paracellular and transcellular delivery components, for any selected glucose-regulating peptide within the invention. For passively absorbed drugs, the relative contribution of paracellular and transcellular pathways to drug transport depends upon the pKa, partition coefficient, molecular radius and charge of the drug, the pH of the luminal environment in which the drug is delivered, and the area of the absorbing surface. The paracellular route represents a relatively small fraction of accessible surface area of the nasal mucosal epithelium. In general terms, it has been reported that cell membranes occupy a mucosal surface area that is a thousand times greater than the area occupied by the paracellular spaces. Thus, the smaller accessible area, and the size- and charge-based discrimination against macromolecular permeation would suggest that the paracellular route would be a generally less favorable route than transcellular delivery for drug transport. Surprisingly, the methods and compositions of the invention provide for significantly enhanced transport of biotherapeutics into and across mucosal epithelia via the paracellular route. Therefore, the methods and compositions of the invention successfully target both paracellular and transcellular routes, alternatively or within a single method or composition.
As used herein, mucosal delivery-enhancing agents include agents which enhance the release or solubility (e.g., from a formulation delivery vehicle), diffusion rate, penetration capacity and timing, uptake, residence time, stability, effective half-life, peak or sustained concentration levels, clearance and other desired mucosal delivery characteristics (e.g., as measured at the site of delivery, or at a selected target site of activity such as the bloodstream or central nervous system) of glucose-regulating peptide or other biologically active compound(s). Enhancement of mucosal delivery can thus occur by any of a variety of mechanisms, for example by increasing the diffusion, transport, persistence or stability of glucose-regulating peptide, increasing membrane fluidity, modulating the availability or action of calcium and other ions that regulate intracellular or paracellular permeation, solubilizing mucosal membrane components (e.g., lipids), changing non-protein and protein sulfhydryl levels in mucosal tissues, increasing water flux across the mucosal surface, modulating epithelial junctional physiology, reducing the viscosity of mucus overlying the mucosal epithelium, reducing mucociliary clearance rates, and other mechanisms.
As used herein, a "mucosally effective amount of glucose-regulating peptide" contemplates effective mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide to a target site for drug activity in the subject that may involve a variety of delivery or transfer routes. For example, a given active agent may find its way through clearances between cells of the mucosa and reach an adjacent vascular wall, while by another route the agent may, either passively or actively, be taken up into mucosal cells to act within the cells or be discharged or transported out of the cells to reach a secondary target site, such as the systemic circulation. The methods and compositions of the invention may promote the translocation of active agents along one or more such alternate routes, or may act directly on the mucosal tissue or proximal vascular tissue to promote absorption or penetration of the active agent(s). The promotion of absorption or penetration in this context is not limited to these mechanisms.
As used herein "peak concentration (Cmax) of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood plasma", "area under concentration vs. time curve (AUC) of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood plasma", "time to maximal plasma concentration (tmax) of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood plasma" are pharmacokinetic parameters known to one skilled in the art. Laursen, et al., Eur. J. Endocrinology /35:309-315, 1996. The "concentration vs. time curve" measures the concentration of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood serum of a subject vs. time after administration of a dosage of glucose-regulating peptide to the subject either by intranasal, intramuscular, subcutaneous, or other parenteral route of administration. "Cmax" is the maximum concentration of glucose-regulating peptide in the blood serum of a subject following a single dosage of glucose-regulating peptide to the subject. "tmax" is the time to reach maximum concentration of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood serum of a subject following administration of a single dosage of glucose-regulating peptide to the subject.
As used herein, "area under concentration vs. time curve (AUC) of glucose-regulating peptide in a blood plasma" is calculated according to the linear trapezoidal rule and with addition of the residual areas. A decrease of 23% or an increase of 30% between two dosages would be detected with a probability of 90% (type II error β = 10%). The "delivery rate" or "rate of absorption" is estimated by comparison of the time (tmax) to reach the maximum concentration (Cmax). Both Cmax and tmax are analyzed using non-parametric methods. Comparisons of the pharmacokinetics of intramuscular, subcutaneous, intravenous and intranasal glucose-regulating peptide administrations were performed by analysis of variance (ANOVA). For pair wise comparisons a Bonferroni-Holmes sequential procedure is used to evaluate significance. The dose-response relationship between the three nasal doses is estimated by regression analysis. P <0.05 is considered significant. Results are given as mean values +/- SEM. While the mechanism of absorption promotion may vary with different mucosal delivery- enhancing agents of the invention, useful reagents in this context will not substantially adversely affect the mucosal tissue and will be selected according to the physicochemical characteristics of the particular glucose-regulating peptide or other active or delivery-enhancing agent. In this context, delivery-enhancing agents that increase penetration or permeability of mucosal tissues will often result in some alteration of the protective permeability barrier of the mucosa. For such delivery-enhancing agents to be of value within the invention, it is generally desired that any significant changes in permeability of the mucosa be reversible within a time frame appropriate to the desired duration of drug delivery. Furthermore, there should be no substantial, cumulative toxicity, nor any permanent deleterious changes induced in the barrier properties of the mucosa with long-term use.
Within certain aspects of the invention, absorption-promoting agents for coordinate administration or combinatorial formulation with glucose-regulating peptide of the invention are selected from small hydrophilic molecules, including but not limited to, dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO), dimethylformamide, ethanol, propylene glycol, and the 2-pyrrolidones. Alternatively, long-chain amphipathic molecules, for example, deacylmethyl sulfoxide, azone, sodium laurylsulfate, oleic acid, and the bile salts, may be employed to enhance mucosal penetration of the glucose-regulating peptide. In additional aspects, surfactants (e.g., polysorbates) are employed as adjunct compounds, processing agents, or formulation additives to enhance intranasal delivery of the glucose-regulating peptide. Agents such as DMSO, polyethylene
I2 glycol, and ethanol can, if present in sufficiently high concentrations in delivery environment (e.g., by pre-administration or incorporation in a therapeutic formulation), enter the aqueous phase of the mucosa and alter its solubilizing properties, thereby enhancing the partitioning of the glucose-regulating peptide from the vehicle into the mucosa.
Additional mucosal delivery-enhancing agents that are useful within the coordinate administration and processing methods and combinatorial formulations of the invention include, but are not limited to, mixed micelles; enamines; nitric oxide donors (e.g., S-nitroso-N-acetyl- DL-penicillamine, NORl, N0R4~which are preferably co-administered with an NO scavenger such as carboxy-PUO or doclofenac sodium); sodium salicylate; glycerol esters of acetoacetic acid (e.g., glyceryl- 1,3-diacetoacetate or l^-isopropylideneglycerine-S-acetoacetate); and other release-diffusion or intra- or trans-epithelial penetration-promoting agents that are physiologically compatible for mucosal delivery. Other absorption-promoting agents are selected from a variety of carriers, bases and excipients that enhance mucosal delivery, stability, activity or trans-epithelial penetration of the glucose-regulating peptide. These include, inter alia, cyclodextrins and β-cyclodextrin derivatives (e.g., 2-hydroxypropyl-β-cyclodextrin and heptakis(2,6-di-0-methyl-β-cyclodextrin). These compounds, optionally conjugated with one or more of the active ingredients and further optionally formulated in an oleaginous base, enhance bioavailability in the mucosal formulations of the invention. Yet additional absorption- enhancing agents adapted for mucosal delivery include medium-chain fatty acids, including mono- and diglycerides (e.g., sodium caprate-extracts of coconut oil, Capmul), and triglycerides (e.g., amylodextrin, Estaram 299, Miglyol 810).
The mucosal therapeutic and prophylactic compositions of the present invention may be supplemented with any suitable penetration-promoting agent that facilitates absorption, diffusion, or penetration of glucose-regulating peptide across mucosal barriers. The penetration promoter may be any promoter that is pharmaceutically acceptable. Thus, in more detailed aspects of the invention compositions are provided that incorporate one or more penetration- promoting agents selected from sodium salicylate and salicylic acid derivatives (acetyl salicylate, choline salicylate, salicylamide, etc.); amino acids and salts thereof (e.g., monoaminocarboxlic acids such as glycine, alanine, phenylalanine, proline, hydroxyproline, etc.; hydroxyamino acids such as serine; acidic amino acids such as aspartic acid, glutamic acid, etc; and basic amino acids such as lysine etc — inclusive of their alkali metal or alkaline earth metal salts); and
N-acetylamino acids (N-acerylalanine, N-acetylphenylalanine, N-acetylserine, N-acetylglycine, N-acetyllysine, N-acetylglutamic acid, N-acetylproline, N-acetylhydroxyproline, etc.) and their salts (alkali metal salts and alkaline earth metal salts). Also provided as penetration-promoting agents within the methods and compositions of the invention are substances which are generally used as emulsifiers (e.g., sodium oleyl phosphate, sodium lauryl phosphate, sodium lauryl sulfate, sodium myristyl sulfate, polyoxyethylene alkyl ethers, poly oxy ethylene alkyl esters, etc.), caproic acid, lactic acid, malic acid and citric acid and alkali metal salts thereof, pyrrolidonecarboxylic acids, alkylpyrrolidonecarboxylic acid esters, N-alkylpyrrolidones, proline acyl esters, and the like.
Within various aspects of the invention, improved nasal mucosal delivery formulations and methods are provided that allow delivery of glucose-regulating peptide and other therapeutic agents within the invention across mucosal barriers between administration and selected target sites. Certain formulations are specifically adapted for a selected target cell, tissue or organ, or even a particular disease state. In other aspects, formulations and methods provide for efficient, selective endo- or transcytosis of glucose-regulating peptide specifically routed along a defined intracellular or intercellular pathway. Typically, the glucose-regulating peptide is efficiently loaded at effective concentration levels in a carrier or other delivery vehicle, and is delivered and maintained in a stabilized form, e.g., at the nasal mucosa and/or during passage through intracellular compartments and membranes to a remote target site for drug action (e.g., the blood stream or a defined tissue, organ, or extracellular compartment). The glucose-regulating peptide may be provided in a delivery vehicle or otherwise modified (e.g., in the form of a prodrug), wherein release or activation of the glucose-regulating peptide is triggered by a physiological stimulus (e.g., pH change, lysosomal enzymes, etc.) Often, the glucose-regulating peptide is pharmacologically inactive until it reaches its target site for activity. In most cases, the glucose-regulating peptide and other formulation components are non-toxic and non-immunogenic. In this context, carriers and other formulation components are generally selected for their ability to be rapidly degraded and excreted under physiological conditions. At the same time, formulations are chemically and physically stable in dosage form for effective storage.
Peptide and Protein Analogs and Mimetics
Included within the definition of biologically active peptides and proteins for use within the invention are natural or synthetic, therapeutically or prophylactically active, peptides (comprised of two or more covalently linked amino acids), proteins, peptide or protein fragments, peptide or protein analogs, and chemically modified derivatives or salts of active peptides or proteins. A wide variety of useful analogs and mimetics of glucose-regulating peptide are contemplated for use within the invention and can be produced and tested for biological activity according to known methods. Often, the peptides or proteins of glucose- regulating peptide or other biologically active peptides or proteins for use within the invention are muteins that are readily obtainable by partial substitution, addition, or deletion of amino acids within a naturally occurring or native (e.g., wild-type, naturally occurring mutant, or allelic variant) peptide or protein sequence. Additionally, biologically active fragments of native peptides or proteins are included. Such mutant derivatives and fragments substantially retain the desired biological activity of the native peptide or proteins. In the case of peptides or proteins having carbohydrate chains, biologically active variants marked by alterations in these carbohydrate species are also included within the invention.
As used herein, the term "conservative amino acid substitution" refers to the general interchangeability of amino acid residues having similar side chains. For example, a commonly interchangeable group of amino acids having aliphatic side chains is alanine, valine, leucine, and isoleucine; a group of amino acids having aliphatic-hydroxyl side chains is serine and threonine; a group of amino acids having amide-containing side chains is asparagine and glutamine; a group of amino acids having aromatic side chains is phenylalanine, tyrosine, and tryptophan; a group of amino acids having basic side chains is lysine, arginine, and histidine; and a group of amino acids having sulfur-containing side chains is cysteine and methionine. Examples of conservative substitutions include the substitution of a non-polar (hydrophobic) residue such as isoleucine, valine, leucine or methionine for another. Likewise, the present invention contemplates the substitution of a polar (hydrophilic) residue such as between arginine and lysine, between glutamine and asparagine, and between threonine and serine. Additionally, the substitution of a basic residue such as lysine, arginine or histidine for another or the substitution of an acidic residue such as aspartic acid or glutamic acid for another is also contemplated. Exemplary conservative amino acids substitution groups are: valine-leucine-isoleucine, phenylalanine- tyrosine, lysine-arginine, alanine-valine, and asparagine-glutamine. By aligning a peptide or protein analog optimally with a corresponding native peptide or protein, and by using appropriate assays, e.g., adhesion protein or receptor binding assays, to determine a selected biological activity, one can readily identify operable peptide and protein analogs for use within the methods and compositions of the invention. Operable peptide and protein analogs are typically specifically immunoreactive with antibodies raised to the corresponding native peptide or protein. An approach for stabilizing solid protein formulations of the invention is to increase the physical stability of purified, e.g., lyophilized protein. This will inhibit aggregation via hydrophobic interactions as well as via covalent pathways that may increase as proteins unfold. Stabilizing formulations in this context often include polymer-based formulations, for example a biodegradable hydrogel formulation/delivery system. As noted above, the critical role of water in protein structure, function, and stability is well known. Typically, proteins are relatively stable in the solid state with bulk water removed. However, solid therapeutic protein formulations may become hydrated upon storage at elevated humidities or during delivery from a sustained release composition or device. The stability of proteins generally drops with increasing hydration. Water can also play a significant role in solid protein aggregation, for example, by increasing protein flexibility resulting in enhanced accessibility of reactive groups, by providing a mobile phase for reactants, and by serving as a reactant in several deleterious processes such as beta-elimination and hydrolysis.
Protein preparations containing between about 6% to 28% water are the most unstable. Below this level, the mobility of bound water and protein internal motions are low. Above this level, water mobility and protein motions approach those of full hydration. Up to a point, increased susceptibility toward solid-phase aggregation with increasing hydration has been observed in several systems. However, at higher water content, less aggregation is observed because of the dilution effect.
In accordance with these principles, an effective method for stabilizing peptides and proteins against solid-state aggregation for mucosal delivery is to control the water content in a solid formulation and maintain the water activity in the formulation at optimal levels. This level depends on the nature of the protein, but in general, proteins maintained below their "monolayer" water coverage will exhibit superior solid-state stability.
A variety of additives, diluents, bases and delivery vehicles are provided within the invention, that effectively control water content to enhance protein stability. These reagents and carrier materials effective as anti-aggregation agents in this sense include, for example, polymers of various functionalities, such as polyethylene glycol, dextran, diethylaminoethyl dextran, and carboxymethyl cellulose, which significantly increase the stability and reduce the solid-phase aggregation of peptides and proteins admixed therewith or linked thereto. In some instances, the activity or physical stability of proteins can also be enhanced by various additives to aqueous solutions of the peptide or protein drugs. For example, additives, such as polyols (including sugars), amino acids, proteins such as collagen and gelatin, and various salts may be used.
Certain additives, in particular sugars and other polyols, also impart significant physical stability to dry, e.g., lyophilized proteins. These additives can also be used within the invention to protect the proteins against aggregation not only during lyophilization but also during storage in the dry state. For example sucrose and Ficoll 70 (a polymer with sucrose units) exhibit significant protection against peptide or protein aggregation during solid-phase incubation under various conditions. These additives may also enhance the stability of solid proteins embedded within polymer matrices. Yet additional additives, for example sucrose, stabilize proteins against solid-state aggregation in humid atmospheres at elevated temperatures, as may occur in certain sustained- release formulations of the invention. Proteins such as gelatin and collagen also serve as stabilizing or bulking agents to reduce denaturation and aggregation of unstable proteins in this context. These additives can be incorporated into polymeric melt processes and compositions within the invention. For example, polypeptide microparticles can be prepared by simply lyophilizing or spray drying a solution containing various stabilizing additives described above. Sustained release of unaggregated peptides and proteins can thereby be obtained over an extended period of time.
Various additional preparative components and methods, as well as specific formulation additives, are provided herein which yield formulations for mucosal delivery of aggregation- prone peptides and proteins, wherein the peptide or protein is stabilized in a substantially pure, unaggregated form using a solubilization agent. A range of components and additives are contemplated for use within these methods and formulations. Exemplary of these solubilization agents are cyclodextrins (CDs), which selectively bind hydrophobic side chains of polypeptides. These CDs have been found to bind to hydrophobic patches of proteins in a manner that significantly inhibits aggregation. This inhibition is selective with respect to both the CD and the protein involved. Such selective inhibition of protein aggregation provides additional advantages within the intranasal delivery methods and compositions of the invention. Additional agents for use in this context include CD dimers, trimers and tetramers with varying geometries controlled by the linkers that specifically block aggregation of peptides and protein. Yet solubilization agents and methods for incorporation within the invention involve the use of peptides and peptide mimetics to selectively block protein-protein interactions. In one aspect, the specific binding of hydrophobic side chains reported for CD multimers is extended to proteins via the use of peptides and peptide mimetics that similarly block protein aggregation. A wide range of suitable methods and anti-aggregation agents are available for incorporation within the compositions and procedures of the invention.
Charge Modifying and pH Control Agents and Methods
To improve the transport characteristics of biologically active agents (including glucose- regulating peptide, other active peptides and proteins, and macromolecular and small molecule drugs) for enhanced delivery across hydrophobic mucosal membrane barriers, the invention also provides techniques and reagents for charge modification of selected biologically active agents or delivery-enhancing agents described herein. In this regard, the relative permeabilities of macromolecules is generally be related to their partition coefficients. The degree of ionization of molecules, which is dependent on the pKa of the molecule and the pH at the mucosal membrane surface, also affects permeability of the molecules. Permeation and partitioning of biologically active agents, including glucose-regulating peptide and analogs of the invention, for mucosal delivery may be facilitated by charge alteration or charge spreading of the active agent or permeabilizing agent, which is achieved, for example, by alteration of charged functional groups, by modifying the pH of the delivery vehicle or solution in which the active agent is delivered, or by coordinate administration of a charge- or pH-altering reagent with the active agent.
Consistent with these general teachings, mucosal delivery of charged macromolecular species, including glucose-regulating peptide and other biologically active peptides and proteins, within the methods and compositions of the invention is substantially improved when the active agent is delivered to the mucosal surface in a substantially un-ionized, or neutral, electrical charge state.
Certain glucose-regulating peptide and other biologically active peptide and protein components of mucosal formulations for use within the invention will be charge modified to yield an increase in the positive charge density of the peptide or protein. These modifications extend also to cationization of peptide and protein conjugates, carriers and other delivery forms disclosed herein. Cationization offers a convenient means of altering the biodistribution and transport properties of proteins and macromolecules within the invention. Cationization is undertaken in a manner that substantially preserves the biological activity of the active agent and limits potentially adverse side effects, including tissue damage and toxicity.
Buffers
A "buffer" is generally used to maintain the pH of a solution at a nearly constant value. A buffer maintains the pH of a solution, even when small amounts of strong acid or strong base are added to the solution, by preventing or neutralizing large changes in concentrations of hydrogen and hydroxide ions. A buffer generally consists of a weak acid and its appropriate salt (or a weak base and its appropriate salt). The appropriate salt for a weak acid contains the same negative ion as present in the weak acid (see Lagowski, Macmillan Encyclopedia of Chemistry, Vol. 1, Simon & Schuster, New York, 1997, pp. 273-4). The Henderson-Hasselbach Equation, pH = pKa + loglO [A-]/[HA], is used to describe a buffer, and is based on the standard equation for weak acid dissociation, HA ^ H+ + A-. Examples of commonly used buffer sources include the following: glutamate, acetate, citrate, glycine, histidine, arginine, lysine, methionine, lactate, formate, glycolate, tartrate, phosphate and mixtures thereof.
The "buffer capacity" means the amount of acid or base that can be added to a buffer solution before a significant pH change will occur. If the pH lies within the range of pK-1 and pK+1 of the weak acid the buffer capacity is appreciable, but outside this range it falls off to such an extent as to be of little value. Therefore, a given system only has a useful buffer action in a range of one pH unit on either side of the pK of the weak acid (or weak base) (see Dawson, Data for Biochemical Research, Third Edition, Oxford Science Publications, 1986, p. 419). Generally, suitable concentrations are chosen so that the pH of the solution is close to the pKa of the weak acid (or weak base) (see Lide, CRC Handbook of Chemistry and Physics, 86th Edition, Taylor & Francis Group, 2005-2006, pp. 2-41). Further, solutions of strong acids and bases are not normally classified as buffer solutions, and they do not display buffer capacity between pH values 2.4 to 11.6.
Degradative Enzyme Inhibitory Agents and Methods Another excipient that may be included in a trans-mucosal preparation is a degradative enzyme inhibitor. Exemplary mucoadhesive polymer-enzyme inhibitor complexes that are useful within the mucosal delivery formulations and methods of the invention include, but are not limited to: Carboxymethylcellulose-pepstatin (with anti-pepsin activity); Poly(acrylic acid)- Bowman-Birk inhibitor (anti-chymotrypsin); Poly(acrylic acid)-chymostatin (anti- chymotrypsin); Poly(acrylic acid)-elastatinal (anti-elastase); Carboxymethylcellulose-elastatinal (anti-elastase); Polycarbophil — elastatinal (anti-elastase); Chitosan — antipain (anti-trypsin); Poly(acrylic acid) — bacitracin (anti-aminopeptidase N); Chitosan — EDTA (anti-aminopeptidase N, anti-carboxypeptidase A); Chitosan — EDTA — antipain (anti-trypsin, anti-chymotrypsin, anti- elastase). As described in further detail below, certain embodiments of the invention will optionally incorporate a novel chitosan derivative or chemically modified form of chitosan. One such novel derivative for use within the invention is denoted as a β-[l— »4]-2-guanidino-2-deoxy- D-glucose polymer (poly-GuD).
Any inhibitor that inhibits the activity of an enzyme to protect the biologically active agent(s) may be usefully employed in the compositions and methods of the invention. Useful enzyme inhibitors for the protection of biologically active proteins and peptides include, for example, soybean trypsin inhibitor, exendin trypsin inhibitor, chymotrypsin inhibitor and trypsin and chrymotrypsin inhibitor isolated from potato (solanum tuberosum L.) tubers. A combination or mixtures of inhibitors may be employed. Additional inhibitors of proteolytic enzymes for use within the invention include ovomucoid-enzyme, gabaxate mesylate, alpha 1 -antitrypsin, aprotinin, amastatin, bestatin, puromycin, bacitracin, leupepsin, alpha2-macroglobulin, pepstatin and egg white or soybean trypsin inhibitor. These and other inhibitors can be used alone or in combination. The inhibitors) may be incorporated in or bound to a carrier, e.g., a hydrophilic polymer, coated on the surface of the dosage form which is to contact the nasal mucosa, or incorporated in the superficial phase of the surface, in combination with the biologically active agent or in a separately administered (e.g., pre-administered) formulation.
The amount of the inhibitor, e.g., of a proteolytic enzyme inhibitor that is optionally incorporated in the compositions of the invention will vary depending on (a) the properties of the specific inhibitor, (b) the number of functional groups present in the molecule (which may be reacted to introduce ethylenic unsaturation necessary for copolymerization with hydrogel forming monomers), and (c) the number of lectin groups, such as glycosides, which are present in the inhibitor molecule. It may also depend on the specific therapeutic agent that is intended to be administered. Generally speaking, a useful amount of an enzyme inhibitor is from about 0.1 mg/ml to about 50 mg/ml, often from about 0.2 mg/ml to about 25 mg/ml, and more commonly from about 0.5 mg/ml to 5 mg/ml of the of the formulation (i.e., a separate protease inhibitor formulation or combined formulation with the inhibitor and biologically active agent). In the case of trypsin inhibition, suitable inhibitors may be selected from, e.g., aprotinin, BBI, soybean trypsin inhibitor, chicken ovomucoid, chicken ovoinhibitor, human exendin trypsin inhibitor, camostat mesilate, flavonoid inhibitors, antipain, leupeptin , p-aminobenzamidine, AEBSF, TLCK (tosyllysine chloromethylketone), APMSF, DFP, PMSF, and poly(acrylate) derivatives. In the case of chymotrypsin inhibition, suitable inhibitors may be selected from, e.g., aprotinin, BBI, soybean trypsin inhibitor, chymostatin, benzyloxycarbonyl-Pro-Phe-CHO, FK-448, chicken ovoinhibitor, sugar biphenylboronic acids complexes, DFP, PMSF, β-phenylpropionate, and poly(acrylate) derivatives. In the case of elastase inhibition, suitable inhibitors may be selected from, e.g., elastatinal, methoxysuccinyl-Ala-Ala-Pro-Val- chloromcthylkctonc (MPCMK), BBI, soybean trypsin inhibitor, chicken ovoinhibitor, DFP, and PMSF.
Additional enzyme inhibitors for use within the invention are selected from a wide range of non-protein inhibitors that vary in their degree of potency and toxicity. As described in further detail below, immobilization of these adjunct agents to matrices or other delivery vehicles, or development of chemically modified analogues, may be readily implemented to reduce or even eliminate toxic effects, when they are encountered. Among this broad group of candidate enzyme inhibitors for use within the invention are organophosphorous inhibitors, such as diisopropylfluorophosphate (DFP) and phenylmethylsulfonyl fluoride (PMSF), which are potent, irreversible inhibitors of serine proteases (e.g., trypsin and chymotrypsin). The additional inhibition of acetylcholinesterase by these compounds makes them highly toxic in uncontrolled delivery settings. Another candidate inhibitor, 4-(2-Aminoethyl)-benzenesulfonyl fluoride (AEBSF), has an inhibitory activity comparable to DFP and PMSF, but it is markedly less toxic. (4-Aminophenyl)-methanesulfonyl fluoride hydrochloride (APMSF) is another potent inhibitor of trypsin, but is toxic in uncontrolled settings. In contrast to these inhibitors, 4-(4- isopropylpiperadinocarbonyl)phenyl 1, 2,3,4, -tetrahydro-1-naphthoate methanesulphonate (FK-448) is a low toxic substance, representing a potent and specific inhibitor of chymotrypsin. Further representatives of this non-protein group of inhibitor candidates, and also exhibiting low toxic risk, are camostat mesilate (N,N'-dimethyl carbamoylmethyl-p-(p '-guanidino- benzoyloxy)phenylacetate methane-sulphonate).
Yet another type of enzyme inhibitory agent for use within the methods and compositions of the invention are amino acids and modified amino acids that interfere with enzymatic degradation of specific therapeutic compounds. For use in this context, amino acids and modified amino acids are substantially non-toxic and can be produced at a low cost. However, due to their low molecular size and good solubility, they are readily diluted and absorbed in mucosal environments. Nevertheless, under proper conditions, amino acids can act as reversible, competitive inhibitors of protease enzymes. Certain modified amino acids can display a much stronger inhibitory activity. A desired modified amino acid in this context is known as a 'transition-state' inhibitor. The strong inhibitory activity of these compounds is based on their structural similarity to a substrate in its transition-state geometry, while they are generally selected to have a much higher affinity for the active site of an enzyme than the substrate itself. Transition-state inhibitors are reversible, competitive inhibitors. Examples of this type of inhibitor are α-aminoboronic acid derivatives, such as boro-leucine, boro-valine and boro-alanine. The boron atom in these derivatives can form a tetrahedral boronate ion that is believed to resemble the transition state of peptides during their hydrolysis by aminopeptidases. These amino acid derivatives arc potent and reversible inhibitors of aminopeptidases and it is reported that boro-leucine is more than 100-times more effective in enzyme inhibition than bestatin and more than 1000-times more effective than puromycin. Another modified amino acid for which a strong protease inhibitory activity has been reported is N-acetylcysteine, which inhibits enzymatic activity of aminopeptidase N. This adjunct agent also displays mucolytic properties that can be employed within the methods and compositions of the invention to reduce the effects of the mucus diffusion barrier.
Still other useful enzyme inhibitors for use within the coordinate administration methods and combinatorial formulations of the invention may be selected from peptides and modified peptide enzyme inhibitors. An important representative of this class of inhibitors is the cyclic dodecapeptide, bacitracin, obtained from Bacillus licheniformis. In addition to these types of peptides, certain dipeptides and tripeptides display weak, non-specific inhibitory activity towards some protease. By analogy with amino acids, their inhibitory activity can be improved by chemical modifications. For example, phosphinic acid dipeptide analogues are also 'transition- state' inhibitors with a strong inhibitory activity towards aminopeptidases. They have reportedly been used to stabilize nasally administered leucine enkephalin. Another example of a transition- state analogue is the modified pentapeptide pepstatin, which is a very potent inhibitor of pepsin. Structural analysis of pepstatin, by testing the inhibitory activity of several synthetic analogues, demonstrated the major structure-function characteristics of the molecule responsible for the inhibitory activity. Another special type of modified peptide includes inhibitors with a terminally located aldehyde function in their structure. For example, the sequence benzyloxycarbonyl-Pro-Phe-CHO, which fulfills the known primary and secondary specificity requirements of chymotrypsin, has been found to be a potent reversible inhibitor of this target proteinase. The chemical structures of further inhibitors with a terminally located aldehyde function, e.g., antipain, leupeptin, chymostatin and elastatinal, are also known in the art, as are the structures of other known, reversible, modified peptide inhibitors, such as phosphoramidon, bestatin, puromycin and amastatin.
Due to their comparably high molecular mass, polypeptide protease inhibitors are more amenable than smaller compounds to concentrated delivery in a drug-carrier matrix. Additional agents for protease inhibition within the formulations and methods of the invention involve the use of complexing agents. These agents mediate enzyme inhibition by depriving the intranasal environment (or preparative or therapeutic composition) of divalent cations, which are co-factors for many proteases. For instance, the complexing agents EDTA and DTPA as coordinately administered or combinatorially formulated adjunct agents, in suitable concentration, will be sufficient to inhibit selected proteases to thereby enhance intranasal delivery of biologically active agents according to the invention. Further representatives of this class of inhibitory agents are EGTA, 1,10-phenanthroline and hydroxychinoline. In addition, due to their propensity to chelate divalent cations, these and other complexing agents are useful within the invention as direct, absorption-promoting agents. As noted in more detail elsewhere herein, it is also contemplated to use various polymers, particularly mucoadhesive polymers, as enzyme inhibiting agents within the coordinate administration, multi-processing and/or combinatorial formulation methods and compositions of the invention. For example, poly(acrylate) derivatives, such as poly(acrylic acid) and polycarbophil, can affect the activity of various proteases, including trypsin, chymotrypsin. The inhibitory effect of these polymers may also be based on the complexation of divalent cations such as Ca2+ and Zn2+. It is further contemplated that these polymers may serve as conjugate partners or carriers for additional enzyme inhibitory agents, as described above. For example, a chitosan-EDTA conjugate has been developed and is useful within the invention that exhibits a strong inhibitory effect towards the enzymatic activity of zinc-dependent proteases. The mucoadhesive properties of polymers following covalent attachment of other enzyme inhibitors in this context are not expected to be substantially compromised, nor is the general utility of such polymers as a delivery vehicle for biologically active agents within the invention expected to be diminished. On the contrary, the reduced distance between the delivery vehicle and mucosal surface afforded by the mucoadhesive mechanism will minimize presystemic metabolism of the active agent, while the covalently bound enzyme inhibitors remain concentrated at the site of drug delivery, minimizing undesired dilution effects of inhibitors as well as toxic and other side effects caused thereby. In this manner, the effective amount of a coordinately administered enzyme inhibitor can be reduced due to the exclusion of dilution effects.
Exemplary mucoadhesive polymer-enzyme inhibitor complexes that are useful within the mucosal formulations and methods of the invention include, but are not limited to:
Carboxymethylcellulose-pepstatin (with anti-pepsin activity); Poly(acrylic acid)-Bowman-Birk inhibitor (anti-chymotrypsin); Poly(acrylic acid)-chymostatin (anti-chymotrypsin); Poly(acrylic acid)-elastatinal (anti-elastase); Carboxymethylcellulose-elastatinal (anti-elastase); Polycarbophil — elastatinal (anti-elastase); Chitosan — antipain (anti-trypsin); Poly(acrylic acid) — bacitracin (anti-aminopeptidase N); Chitosan — EDTA (anti-aminopeptidase N, anti-carboxypeptidase A); Chitosan — EDTA — antipain (anti-trypsin, anti-chymotrypsin, anti-elastase).
Mucolytic and Mucus-Clearing Agents and Methods
Effective delivery of biotherapeutic agents via intranasal administration must take into account the decreased drug transport rate across the protective mucus lining of the nasal mucosa, in addition to drug loss due to binding to glycoproteins of the mucus layer. Normal mucus is a viscoelastic, gel-like substance consisting of water, electrolytes, mucins, macromolecules, and sloughed epithelial cells. It serves primarily as a cytoprotective and lubricative covering for the underlying mucosal tissues. Mucus is secreted by randomly distributed secretory cells located in the nasal epithelium and in other mucosal epithelia. The structural unit of mucus is mucin. This glycoprotein is mainly responsible for the viscoelastic nature of mucus, although other macromolecules may also contribute to this property. In airway mucus, such macromolecules include locally produced secretory IgA, IgM, IgE, lysozyme, and bronchotransferrin, which also play an important role in host defense mechanisms. The coordinate administration methods of the instant invention optionally incorporate effective mucolytic or mucus-clearing agents, which serve to degrade; thin or clear mucus from intranasal mucosal surfaces to facilitate absorption of intranasally administered biotherapeutic agents. Within these methods, a mucolytic or mucus-clearing agent is coordinately administered as an adjunct compound to enhance intranasal delivery of the biologically active agent.
Alternatively, an effective amount of a mucolytic or mucus-clearing agent is incorporated as a processing agent within a multi-processing method of the invention, or as an additive within a combinatorial formulation of the invention, to provide an improved formulation that enhances intranasal delivery of biotherapeutic compounds by reducing the barrier effects of intranasal mucus.
A variety of mucolytic or mucus-clearing agents are available for incorporation within the methods and compositions of the invention. Based on their mechanisms of action, mucolytic and mucus clearing agents can often be classified into the following groups: proteases (e.g., pronase, papain) that cleave the protein core of mucin glycoproteins; sulfhydryl compounds that split mucoprotein disulfide linkages; and detergents (e.g., Triton X-IOO, Tween 20) that break non-covalent bonds within the mucus. Additional compounds in this context include, but are not limited to, bile salts and surfactants, for example, sodium deoxycholate, sodium taurodeoxycholate, sodium glycocholate, and lysophosphatidylcholine.
The effectiveness of bile salts in causing structural breakdown of mucus is in the order deoxycholate > taurocholate > glycocholate. Other effective agents that reduce mucus viscosity or adhesion to enhance intranasal delivery according to the methods of the invention include, e.g., short-chain fatty acids, and mucolytic agents that work by chelation, such as N-acylcollagen peptides, bile acids, and saponins (the latter function in part by chelating Ca2+ and/or Mg2+ which play an important role in maintaining mucus layer structure). Additional mucolytic agents for use within the methods and compositions of the invention include N-acetyl-L-cysteine (ACS), a potent mucolytic agent that reduces both the viscosity and adherence of bronchopulmonary mucus and is reported to modestly increase nasal bioavailability of human growth hormone in anesthetized rats (from 7.5 to 12.2%). These and other mucolytic or mucus-clearing agents are contacted with the nasal mucosa, typically in a concentration range of about 0.2 to 20 mM, coordinately with administration of the biologically active agent, to reduce the polar viscosity and/or elasticity of intranasal mucus.
Still other mucolytic or mucus-clearing agents may be selected from a range of glycosidase enzymes, which are able to cleave glycosidic bonds within the mucus glycoprotein, α-amylase and β-amylase are representative of this class of enzymes, although their mucolytic effect may be limited. In contrast, bacterial glycosidases which allow these microorganisms to permeate mucus layers of their hosts.
For combinatorial use with most biologically active agents within the invention, including peptide and protein therapeutics, non-ionogenic detergents are generally also useful as mucolytic or mucus-clearing agents. These agents typically will not modify or substantially impair the activity of therapeutic polypeptides.
Viscosity Enhancing Agents
Viscosity enhancing or suspending agents may affect the rate of release of a drug from the dosage formulation and absorption. Some examples of the materials which can serve as pharmaceutically acceptable viscosity enhancing agents are methylcellulose (MC); hydroxypropylmeihylcellulose (HPMC); carboxymethylcellulose (CMC); cellulose; gelatin; starch; heta starch; poloxamers; pluronics; sodium CMC; sorbitol; acacia; povidone; carbopol; polycarbophil; chitosan; chitosan microspheres; alginate microspheres; chitosan glutamate; amberlite resin; hyaluronan; ethyl cellulose; maltodextrin DE; drum-dried way maize starch (DDWM); degradable starch microspheres (DSM); deoxyglycocholate (GDC); hydroxyethyl cellulose (HEC); hydroxypropyl cellulose (HPC); microcrystalline cellulose (MCC); polymethacrylic acid and polyethylene glycol; sulfobutylether B cyclodextrin; cross-linked eldexomer starch biospheres; sodiumtaurodihydrofusidate (STDHF); N-trimethyl chitosan chloride (TMC); degraded starch microspheres; amberlite resin; chistosan nanoparticles; spray-dried crospovidone; spray-dried dextran microspheres; spray-dried microcrystalline cellulose; and cross-linked eldexomer starch microspheres.
Ciliostatic Agents and Methods
Because the self-cleaning capacity of certain mucosal tissues (e.g., nasal mucosal tissues) by mucociliary clearance is necessary as a protective function (e.g., to remove dust, allergens, and bacteria), it has been generally considered that this function should not be substantially impaired by mucosal medications. Mucociliary transport in the respiratory tract is a particularly important defense mechanism against infections. To achieve this function, ciliary beating in the nasal and airway passages moves a layer of mucus along the mucosa to removing inhaled particles and microorganisms. Ciliostatic agents find use within the methods and compositions of the invention to increase the residence time of mucosally (e.g., intranasally) administered glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein. In particular, the delivery these agents within the methods and compositions of the invention is significantly enhanced in certain aspects by the coordinate administration or combinatorial formulation of one or more ciliostatic agents that function to reversibly inhibit ciliary activity of mucosal cells, to provide for a temporary, reversible increase in the residence time of the mucosally administered active agent(s). For use within these aspects of the invention, the foregoing ciliostatic factors, either specific or indirect in their activity, are all candidates for successful employment as ciliostatic agents in appropriate amounts (depending on concentration, duration and mode of delivery) such that they yield a transient (i.e., reversible) reduction or cessation of mucociliary clearance at a mucosal site of administration to enhance delivery of glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein, without unacceptable adverse side effects. Various bacterial ciliostatic factors isolated and characterized in the literature may be employed within the embodiments of the invention. Ciliostatic factors from the bacterium Pseudomonas aeruginosa include a phenazine derivative, a pyo compound (2-alkyl-4- hydroxyquinolines), and a rhamnolipid (also known as a hemolysin). The pyo compound produced ciliostasis at concentrations of 50 μg/ml and without obvious ultrastructural lesions. The phenazine derivative also inhibited ciliary motility but caused some membrane disruption, although at substantially greater concentrations of 400 μg/ml. Limited exposure of tracheal explants to the rhamnolipid resulted in ciliostasis, which is associated with altered ciliary membranes. More extensive exposure to rhamnolipid is associated with removal of dynein arms from axonemes.
Surface Active Agents and Methods
Within more detailed aspects of the invention, one or more membrane penetration- enhancing agents may be employed within a mucosal delivery method or formulation of the invention to enhance mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein. Membrane penetration enhancing agents in this context can be selected from: (i) a surfactant, (ii) a bile salt, (iii) a phospholipid additive, mixed micelle, liposome, or carrier, (iv) an alcohol, (v) an enamine, (vi) a NO donor compound, (vii) a long-chain amphipathic molecule (viii) a small hydrophobic penetration enhancer; (ix) sodium or a salicylic acid derivative; (x) a glycerol ester of acetoacetic acid, (xi) a clyclodextrin or beta-cyclodextrin derivative, (xii) a medium-chain fatty acid, (xiii) a chelating agent, (xiv) an amino acid or salt thereof, (xv) an N-acetylamino acid or salt thereof, (xvi) an enzyme degradative to a selected membrane component, (xvii) an inhibitor of fatty acid synthesis, or (xviii) an inhibitor of cholesterol synthesis; or (xix) any combination of the membrane penetration enhancing agents recited in (i)-( xviii).
Certain surface-active agents are readily incorporated within the mucosal delivery formulations and methods of the invention as mucosal absorption enhancing agents. These agents, which may be coordinately administered or combinatorially formulated with glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein, may be selected from a broad assemblage of known surfactants. Surfactants, which generally fall into three classes: (1) nonionic polyoxyethylene ethers; (2) bile salts such as sodium glycocholate (SGC) and deoxycholate (DOC); and (3) derivatives of fusidic acid such as sodium taurodihydrofusidate (STDHF). The mechanisms of action of these various classes of surface-active agents typically include solubilization of the biologically active agent. For proteins and peptides which often form aggregates, the surface active properties of these absorption promoters can allow interactions with proteins such that smaller units such as surfactant coated monomers may be more readily maintained in solution. Examples of other surface-active agents are L-α-Phosphatidylcholine Didecanoyl (DDPC) polysorbate 80 and polysorbate 20. These monomers are presumably more transportable units than aggregates. A second potential mechanism is the protection of the peptide or protein from proteolytic degradation by proteases in the mucosal environment. Both bile salts and some fusidic acid derivatives reportedly inhibit proteolytic degradation of proteins by nasal homogenates at concentrations less than or equivalent to those required to enhance protein absorption. This protease inhibition may be especially important for peptides with short biological half-lives.
Degradation Enzymes and Inhibitors of Fatty Acid and Cholesterol Synthesis In related aspects of the invention, glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents for mucosal administration are formulated or coordinately administered with a penetration enhancing agent selected from a degradation enayme, or a metabolic stimulatory agent or inhibitor of synthesis of fatty acids, sterols or other selected epithelial barrier components, U.S. Patent No. 6,190,894. For example, degradative en∑ymes such as phospholipase, hyaluronidase, neuraminidase, and chondroitinase may be employed to enhance mucosal penetration of glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agent without causing irreversible damage to the mucosal barrier. In one embodiment, chondroitinase is employed within a method or composition as provided herein to alter glycoprotein or glycolipid constituents of the permeability barrier of the mucosa, thereby enhancing mucosal absorption of glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein.
With regard to inhibitors of synthesis of mucosal barrier constituents, it is noted that free fatty acids account for 20-25% of epithelial lipids by weight. Two rate-limiting enzymes in the biosynthesis of free fatty acids are acetyl CoA carboxylase and fatty acid synthetase. Through a series of steps, free fatty acids are metabolized into phospholipids. Thus, inhibitors of free fatty acid synthesis and metabolism for use within the methods and compositions of the invention include, but are not limited to, inhibitors of acetyl CoA carboxylase such as 5-tetradecyloxy-2- furancarboxylic acid (TOFA); inhibitors of fatty acid synthetase; inhibitors of phospholipase A such as gomisin A, 2-(p-amylcinnamyl)amino-4-chlorobenzoic acid, bromophenacyl bromide, monoalide, 7,7-dimethyl-5,8-eicosadienoic acid, nicergoline, cepharanthine, nicardipine, quercetin, dibutyryl-cyclic AMP, R-24571, N-oleoylethanolamine, N-(7-nitro-2,l,3- benzoxadiazol-4-yl) phosphostidyl serine, cyclosporine A, topical anesthetics, including dibucaine, prenylamine, retinoids, such as all-trans and 13-cis-retinoic acid, W-7, trifluoperazine, R-24571 (calmidazolium), l-hexadocyl-3-trifluoroethyl glycero-sn-2-phosphomenthol (MJ33); calcium channel blockers including nicardipine, verapamil, diltiazem, nifedipine, and nimodipine; antimalarials including quinacrine, mepacrine, chloroquine and hydroxychloroquine; beta blockers including propanalol and labetalol; calmodulin antagonists; EGTA; thimersol; glucocorticosteroids including dexamethasone and prednisolone; and nonsteroidal antiinflammatory agents including indomethacin and naproxen.
Free sterols, primarily cholesterol, account for 20-25% of the epithelial lipids by weight. The rate limiting enzyme in the biosynthesis of cholesterol is 3-hydroxy-3-methylglutaryl (HMG) CoA reductase. Inhibitors of cholesterol synthesis for use within the methods and compositions of the invention include, but are not limited to, competitive inhibitors of (HMG) CoA reductase, such as simvastatin, lovastatin, fluindostatin (fluvastatin), pravastatin, mevastatin, as well as other HMG CoA reductase inhibitors, such as cholesterol oleate, cholesterol sulfate and phosphate, and oxygenated sterols, such as 25-OH— and 26-OH-- cholesterol; inhibitors of squalene synthetase; inhibitors of squalene epoxidase; inhibitors of DELTA7 or DELTA24 reductases such as 22,25-diazacholesterol, 20,25-diazacholestenol, AY9944, and triparanol.
Each of the inhibitors of fatty acid synthesis or the sterol synthesis inhibitors may be coordinately administered or combinatorially formulated with one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein to achieve enhanced epithelial penetration of the active agent(s). An effective concentration range for the sterol inhibitor in a therapeutic or adjunct formulation for mucosal delivery is generally from about 0.0001% to about 20% by weight of the total, more typically from about 0.01% to about 5%.
Nitric Oxide Donor Agents and Methods
Within other related aspects of the invention, a nitric oxide (NO) donor is selected as a membrane penetration-enhancing agent to enhance mucosal delivery of one or more glucose- regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein. Various NO donors are known in the art and are useful in effective concentrations within the methods and formulations of the invention. Exemplary NO donors include, but are not limited to, nitroglycerine, nitropruside, N0C5 [3-(2-hydroxy~l-(methyl-ethyl)-2- nitrosohydrazino)- 1 -propanamine] , NOC 12 [N-ethyl-2-( 1 -ethyl-hydroxy-2-nitrosohydrazino)- ethanamine], SNAP [S-nitroso-N-acetyl-DL-penicillamine], NORI and N0R4. Within the methods and compositions of the invention, an effective amount of a selected NO donor is coordinately administered or combinatorially formulated with one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and/or other biologically active agents disclosed herein, into or through the mucosal epithelium.
Agents for Modulating Epithelial Junction Structure and/or Physiology
The present invention provides pharmaceutical composition that contains one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs or mimetics, and/or other biologically active agents in combination with mucosal delivery enhancing agents disclosed herein formulated in a pharmaceutical preparation for mucosal delivery.
The permeabilizing agent reversibly enhances mucosal epithelial paracellular transport, typically by modulating epithelial junctional structure and/or physiology at a mucosal epithelial surface in the subject. This effect typically involves inhibition by the permeabilizing agent of homotypic or heterotypic binding between epithelial membrane adhesive proteins of neighboring epithelial cells. Target proteins for this blockade of homotypic or heterotypic binding can be selected from various related junctional adhesion molecules (JAMs), occludins, or claudins. Examples of this are antibodies, antibody fragments or single-chain antibodies that bind to the extracellular domains of these proteins. In yet additional detailed embodiments, the invention provides permeabilizing peptides and peptide analogs and mimetics for enhancing mucosal epithelial paracellular transport. The subject peptides and peptide analogs and mimetics typically work within the compositions and methods of the invention by modulating epithelial junctional structure and/or physiology in a mammalian subject. In certain embodiments, the peptides and peptide analogs and mimetics effectively inhibit homotypic and/or heterotypic binding of an epithelial membrane adhesive protein selected from a junctional adhesion molecule (JAM), occludin, or claudin.
One such agent that has been extensively studied is the bacterial toxin from Vibrio cholerae known as the "zonula occludens toxin" (ZOT). This toxin mediates increased intestinal mucosal permeability and causes disease symptoms including diarrhea in infected subjects. Fasano, et al., Proc. Nat. Acad. ScI, U.S.A. 5:5242-5246, 1991. When tested on rabbit ileal mucosa, ZOT increased the intestinal permeability by modulating the structure of intercellular tight junctions. More recently, it has been found that ZOT is capable of reversibly opening tight junctions in the intestinal mucosa. It has also been reported that ZOT is capable of reversibly opening tight junctions in the nasal mucosa. U.S. Patent No. 5,908,825.
Within the methods and compositions of the invention, ZOT, as well as various analogs and mimetics of ZOT that function as agonists or antagonists of ZOT activity, are useful for enhancing intranasal delivery of biologically active agents — by increasing paracellular absorption into and across the nasal mucosa. In this context, ZOT typically acts by causing a structural reorganization of tight junctions marked by altered localization of the junctional protein ZOl. Within these aspects of the invention, ZOT is coordinately administered or combinatorially formulated with the biologically active agent in an effective amount to yield significantly enhanced absorption of the active agent, by reversibly increasing nasal mucosal permeability without substantial adverse side effects.
Vasodilator Agents and Methods
Yet another class of absorption-promoting agents that shows beneficial utility within the coordinate administration and combinatorial formulation methods and compositions of the invention are vasoactive compounds, more specifically vasodilators. These compounds function within the invention to modulate the structure and physiology of the submucosal vasculature, increasing the transport rate of glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents into or through the mucosal epithelium and/or to specific target tissues or compartments (e.g., the systemic circulation or central nervous system.).
Vasodilator agents for use within the invention typically cause submucosal blood vessel relaxation by either a decrease in cytoplasmic calcium, an increase in nitric oxide (NO) or by inhibiting myosin light chain kinase. They are generally divided into 9 classes: calcium antagonists, potassium channel openers, ACE inhibitors, angiotensin-II receptor antagonists, α- adrenergic and imidazole receptor antagonists, βl -adrenergic agonists, phosphodiesterase inhibitors, eicosanoids and NO donors. Despite chemical differences, the pharmacokinetic properties of calcium antagonists are similar. Absorption into the systemic circulation is high, and these agents therefore undergo considerable first-pass metabolism by the liver, resulting in individual variation in pharmacokinetics. Except for the newer drugs of the dihydropyridine type (amlodipine, felodipine, isradipine, nilvadipine, nisoldipine and nitrendipine), the half-life of calcium antagonists is short. Therefore, to maintain an effective drug concentration for many of these may require delivery by multiple dosing, or controlled release formulations, as described elsewhere herein. Treatment with the potassium channel opener minoxidil may also be limited in manner and level of administration due to potential adverse side effects. ACE inhibitors prevent conversion of angiotensin-I to angiotensin-II, and are most effective when renin production is increased. Since ACE is identical to kininase-II, which inactivates the potent endogenous vasodilator bradykinin, ACE inhibition causes a reduction in bradykinin degradation. ACE inhibitors provide the added advantage of cardioprotective and cardioreparative effects, by preventing and reversing cardiac fibrosis and ventricular hypertrophy in animal models. The predominant elimination pathway of most ACE inhibitors is via renal excretion. Therefore, renal impairment is associated with reduced elimination and a dosage reduction of 25 to 50% is recommended in patients with moderate to severe renal impairment.
With regard to NO donors, these compounds are particularly useful within the invention for their additional effects on mucosal permeability. In addition to the above-noted NO donors, complexes of NO with nucleophiles called NO/nucleophiles, or NONOates, spontaneously and nonen2ymatically release NO when dissolved in aqueous solution at physiologic pH. In contrast, nitro vasodilators such as nitroglycerin require specific en:zyme activity for NO release. NONOates release NO with a defined stoichiometry and at predictable rates ranging from <3 minutes for diethylamine/NO to approximately 20 hours for diethylenetriamine/NO (DETANO). Within certain methods and compositions of the invention, a selected vasodilator agent is coordinately administered (e.g., systemically or intranasally, simultaneously or in combinatorially effective temporal association) or combinatorially formulated with one or more glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agent(s) in an amount effective to enhance the mucosal absorption of the active agent(s) to reach a target tissue or compartment in the subject (e.g., the liver, hepatic portal vein, CNS tissue or fluid, or blood plasma).
Selective Transport-Enhancing Agents and Methods
The compositions and delivery methods of the invention optionally incorporate a selective transport-enhancing agent that facilitates transport of one or more biologically active agents. These transport-enhancing agents may be employed in a combinatorial formulation or coordinate administration protocol with one or more of the glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics disclosed herein, to coordinately enhance delivery of one or more additional biologically active agent(s) across mucosal transport barriers, to enhance mucosal delivery of the active agent(s) to reach a target tissue or compartment in the subject (e.g., the mucosal epithelium, liver, CNS tissue or fluid, or blood plasma). Alternatively, the transport- enhancing agents may be employed in a combinatorial formulation or coordinate administration protocol to directly enhance mucosal delivery of one or more of the glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, with or without enhanced delivery of an additional biologically active agent.
Exemplary selective transport-enhancing agents for use within this aspect of the invention include, but are not limited to, glycosides, sugar-containing molecules, and binding agents such as lectin binding agents, which are known to interact specifically with epithelial transport barrier components. For example, specific "bioadhesive" ligands, including various plant and bacterial lectins, which bind to cell surface sugar moieties by receptor-mediated interactions can be employed as carriers or conjugated transport mediators for enhancing mucosal, e.g., nasal delivery of biologically active agents within the invention. Certain bioadhesive ligands for use within the invention will mediate transmission of biological signals to epithelial target cells that trigger selective uptake of the adhesive ligand by specialized cellular transport processes (endocytosis or transcytosis). These transport mediators can therefore be employed as a "carrier system" to stimulate or direct selective uptake of one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agent(s) into and/or through mucosal epithelia. These and other selective transport-enhancing agents significantly enhance mucosal delivery of macromolecular biopharmaceuticals (particularly peptides, proteins, oligonucleotides and polynucleotide vectors) within the invention. Lectins are plant proteins that bind to specific sugars found on the surface of glycoproteins and glycolipids of eukaryotic cells. Concentrated solutions of lectins have a 'mucotractive' effect, and various studies have demonstrated rapid receptor mediated endocytocis (RME) of lectins and lectin conjugates (e.g., concanavalin A conjugated with colloidal gold particles) across mucosal surfaces. Additional studies have reported that the uptake mechanisms for lectins can be utilized for intestinal drug targeting in vivo. In certain of these studies, polystyrene nanoparticles (500 run) were covalently coupled to tomato lectin and reported yielded improved systemic uptake after oral administration to rats. In addition to plant lectins, microbial adhesion and invasion factors provide a rich source of candidates for use as adhesive/selective transport carriers within the mucosal delivery methods and compositions of the invention. Two components are necessary for bacterial adherence processes, a bacterial 'adhesin' (adherence or colonization factor) and a receptor on the host cell surface. Bacteria causing mucosal infections need to penetrate the mucus layer before attaching themselves to the epithelial surface. This attachment is usually mediated by bacterial fimbriae or pilus structures, although other cell surface components may also take part in the process. Adherent bacteria colonize mucosal epithelia by multiplication and initiation of a series of biochemical reactions inside the target cell through signal transduction mechanisms (with or without the help of toxins). Associated with these invasive mechanisms, a wide diversity of bioadhesive proteins (e.g., invasin, interaalin) originally produced by various bacteria and viruses are known. These allow for extracellular attachment of such microorganisms with an impressive selectivity for host species and even particular target tissues. Signals transmitted by such receptor-ligand interactions trigger the transport of intact, living microorganisms into, and eventually through, epithelial cells by endo- and transcytotic processes. Such naturally occurring phenomena may be harnessed (e.g., by complexing biologically active agents such as glucose- regulating peptide with an adhesin) according to the teachings herein for enhanced delivery of biologically active compounds into or across mucosal epithelia and/or to other designated target sites of drug action.
Various bacterial and plant toxins that bind epithelial surfaces in a specific, lectin-like manner are also useful within the methods and compositions of the invention. For example, diptheria toxin (DT) enters host cells rapidly by RME. Likewise, the B subunit of the E. coli heat labile toxin binds to the brush border of intestinal epithelial cells in a highly specific, lectin- like manner. Uptake of this toxin and transcytosis to the basolateral side of the enterocytes has been reported in vivo and in vitro. Other researches have expressed the transmembrane domain of diphtheria toxin in E. coli as a maltose-binding fusion protein and coupled it chemically to high-Mw poly-L-lysine. The resulting complex is successfully used to mediate internalization of a reporter gene in vitro. In addition to these examples, Staphylococcus aureus produces a set of proteins (e.g., staphylococcal enterotoxin A (SEA), SEB, toxic shock syndrome toxin 1 (TSST-I) which act both as superantigens and toxins. Studies relating to these proteins have reported dose-dependent, facilitated transcytosis of SEB and TSST-I in Caco-2 cells.
Viral haemagglutinins comprise another type of transport agent to facilitate mucosal delivery of biologically active agents within the methods and compositions of the invention. The initial step in many viral infections is the binding of surface proteins (haemagglutinins) to mucosal cells. These binding proteins have been identified for most viruses, including rotaviruses, varicella zoster virus, semliM forest virus, adenoviruses, potato leafroll virus, and reovirus. These and other exemplary viral hemagglutinins can be employed in a combinatorial formulation (e.g., a mixture or conjugate formulation) or coordinate administration protocol with one or more of the glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics disclosed herein, to coordinately enhance mucosal delivery of one or more additional biologically active agent(s). Alternatively, viral hemagglutinins can be employed in a combinatorial formulation or coordinate administration protocol to directly enhance mucosal delivery of one or more of the glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, with or without enhanced delivery of an additional biologically active agent. A variety of endogenous, selective transport-mediating factors are also available for use within the invention. Mammalian cells have developed an assortment of mechanisms to facilitate the internalization of specific substrates and target these to defined compartments. Collectively, these processes of membrane deformations are termed 'endocytosis' and comprise phagocytosis, pinocytosis, receptor-mediated endocytosis (clathrin-mediated RME), and potocytosis (non-clathrin-mediated RME). RME is a highly specific cellular biologic process by which, as its name implies, various ligands bind to cell surface receptors and are subsequently internalized and trafficked within the cell. In many cells the process of endocytosis is so active that the entire membrane surface is internalized and replaced in less than a half hour. Two classes of receptors are proposed based on their orientation in the cell membrane; the amino terminus of Type I receptors is located on the extracellular side of the membrane, whereas Type II receptors have this same protein tail in the intracellular milieu.
Still other embodiments of the invention utilize transferrin as a carrier or stimulant of RME of mucosally delivered biologically active agents. Transferrin, an 80 kDa iron-transporting glycoprotein, is efficiently taken up into cells by RME. Transferrin receptors are found on the surface of most proliferating cells, in elevated numbers on erythroblasts and on many kinds of tumors. The transcytosis of transferrin (Tf) and transferrin conjugates is reportedly enhanced in the presence of Brefeldin A (BFA), a fungal metabolite. In other studies, BFA treatment has been reported to rapidly increase apical endocytosis of both ricin and HRP in MDCK cells. Thus, BFA and other agents that stimulate receptor-mediated transport can be employed within the methods of the invention as combinatorially formulated (e.g., conjugated) and/or coordinately administered agents to enhance receptor-mediated transport of biologically active agents, including glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics.
Polymeric Delivery Vehicles and Methods
Within certain aspects of the invention, glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, other biologically active agents disclosed herein, and delivery-enhancing agents as described above, are, individually or combinatorially, incorporated within a mucosally (e.g., nasally) administered formulation that includes a biocompatible polymer functioning as a carrier or base. Such polymer carriers include polymeric powders, matrices or microparticulate delivery vehicles, among other polymer forms. The polymer can be of plant, animal, or synthetic origin. Often the polymer is crosslinked. Additionally, in these delivery systems the glucose-regulating peptide, analog or mimetic, can be functionalized in a manner where it can be covalently bound to the polymer and rendered inseparable from the polymer by simple ishing. In other embodiments, the polymer is chemically modified with an inhibitor of enzymes or other agents which may degrade or inactivate the biologically active agent(s) and/or delivery enhancing agent(s). In certain formulations, the polymer is a partially or completely water insoluble but water swellable polymer, e.g., ahydrogel. Polymers useful in this aspect of the invention are desirably water interactive and/or hydrophilic in nature to absorb significant quantities of water, and they often form hydrogels when placed in contact with water or aqueous media for a period of time sufficient to reach equilibrium with water. In more detailed embodiments, the polymer is a hydrogel which, when placed in contact with excess water, absorbs at least two times its weight of water at equilibrium when exposed to water at room temperature, U.S. Patent No. 6,004,583.
Drug delivery systems based on biodegradable polymers are preferred in many biomedical applications because such systems are broken down either by hydrolysis or by enzymatic reaction into non-toxic molecules. The rate of degradation is controlled by manipulating the composition of the biodegradable polymer matrix. These types of systems can therefore be employed in certain settings for long-term release of biologically active agents. Biodegradable polymers such as poly(glycolic acid) (PGA), poly-(lactic acid) (PLA), and poly(D,L-lactic-co-glycolic acid) (PLGA), have received considerable attention as possible drug delivery carriers, since the degradation products of these polymers have been found to have low toxicity. During the normal metabolic function of the body these polymers degrade into carbon dioxide and water. These polymers have also exhibited excellent biocompatibility.
For prolonging the biological activity of glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein, as well as optional delivery- enhancing agents, these agents may be incorporated into polymeric matrices, e.g., polyorthoesters, polyanhydrides, or polyesters. This yields sustained activity and release of the active agent(s), e.g., as determined by the degradation of the polymer matrix. Although the encapsulation of biotherapeutic molecules inside synthetic polymers may stabilize them during storage and delivery, the largest obstacle of polymer-based release technology is the activity loss of the therapeutic molecules during the formulation processes that often involve heat, sonication or organic solvents.
Absorption-promoting polymers contemplated for use within the invention may include derivatives and chemically or physically modified versions of the foregoing types of polymers, in addition to other naturally occurring or synthetic polymers, gums, resins, and other agents, as well as blends of these materials with each other or other polymers, so long as the alterations, modifications or blending do not adversely affect the desired properties, such as water absorption, hydrogel formation, and/or chemical stability for useful application. In more detailed aspects of the invention, polymers such as nylon, acrylan and other normally hydrophobic synthetic polymers may be sufficiently modified by reaction to become water swellable and/or form stable gels in aqueous media.
Absorption-promoting polymers of the invention may include polymers from the group of homo- and copolymers based on various combinations of the following vinyl monomers: acrylic and methacrylic acids, acrylamide, methacrylamide, hydroxyethylacrylate or methacrylate, vinylpyrrolidones, as well as polyvinylalcohol and its co- and terpolymers, polyvinylacetate, its co- and terpolymers with the above listed monomers and 2-acrylamido-2- methyl-propanesulfonic acid (AMPS®). Very useful are copolymers of the above listed monomers with copolymerizable functional monomers such as acryl or methacryl amide acrylate or methacrylate esters where the ester groups are derived from straight or branched chain alkyl, aryl having up to four aromatic rings which may contain alkyl substituents of 1 to 6 carbons; steroidal, sulfates, phosphates or cationic monomers such as N,N-dimethylaminoalkyl(meth)acrylamide, dimethylaminoalkyl(meth)acrylate, (meth)acryloxyalkyltrimethylammonium chloride, (meth)acryloxyalkyldimethylben2yl ammonium chloride. Additional absorption-promoting polymers for use within the invention are those classified as dextrans, dextrins, and from the class of materials classified as natural gums and resins, or from the class of natural polymers such as processed collagen, chitin, chitosan, pullalan, zooglan, alginates and modified alginates such as "Kelcoloid" (a polypropylene glycol modified alginate) gellan gums such as "Kelocogel", Xanathan gums such as "Keltrol", estastin, alpha hydroxy butyrate and its copolymers, hyaluronic acid and its derivatives, polylactic and glycolic acids.
A very useful class of polymers applicable within the instant invention are olefinically- unsaturated carboxylic acids containing at least one activated carbon-to-carbon olefϊnic double bond, and at least one carboxyl group; that is, an acid or functional group readily converted to an acid containing an olefinic double bond which readily functions in polymerization because of its presence in the monomer molecule, either in the alpha-beta position with respect to a carboxyl group, or as part of a terminal methylene grouping. Olefinically-unsaturated acids of this class include such materials as the acrylic acids typified by the acrylic acid itself, alpha-cyano acrylic acid, beta methylacrylic acid (crotonic acid), alpha-phenyl acrylic acid, beta-acryloxy propionic acid, cinnamic acid, p-chloro cinnamic acid, l-carboxy-4-phenyl butadiene- 1,3, itaconic acid, citraconic acid, mesaconic acid, glutaconic acid, aconitic acid, maleic acid, fumaric acid, and tricarboxy ethylene. As used herein, the term "carboxylic acid" includes the polycarboxylic acids and those acid anhydrides, such as maleic anhydride, wherein the anhydride group is formed by the elimination of one molecule of water from two carboxyl groups located on the same carboxylic acid molecule.
Representative acrylates useful as absorption-promoting agents within the invention include methyl acrylate, ethyl acrylate, propyl acrylate, isopropyl acrylate, butyl acrylate, isobutyl acrylate, methyl methacrylate, methyl ethacrylate, ethyl methacrylate, octyl acrylate, heptyl acrylate, octyl methacrylate, isopropyl methacrylate, 2-ethylhexyl methacrylate, nonyl acrylate, hexyl acrylate, n-hexyl methacrylate, and the like. Higher alkyl acrylic esters are decyl acrylate, isodecyl methacrylate, lauryl acrylate, stearyl acrylate, behenyl acrylate and melissyl acrylate and methacrylate versions thereof. Mixtures of two or three or more long chain acrylic esters may be successfully polymerized with one of the carboxylic monomers. Other comonomers include olefins, including alpha olefins, vinyl ethers, vinyl esters, and mixtures thereof.
Other vinylidene monomers, including the acrylic nitriles, may also be used as absorption-promoting agents within the methods and compositions of the invention to enhance delivery and absorption of one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agent(s), including to enhance delivery of the active agent(s) to a target tissue or compartment in the subject (e.g., the liver, hepatic portal vein, CNS tissue or fluid, or blood plasma). Useful alpha, beta-olefinically unsaturated nitriles are preferably monoolefinically unsaturated nitriles having from 3 to 10 carbon atoms such as acrylonitrile, methacrylonitrile, and the like. Most preferred are acrylonitrile and methacrylonitrile. Acrylic amides containing from 3 to 35 carbon atoms including monoolefinically unsaturated amides also may be used. Representative amides include acrylamide, methacrylamide, N-t-butyl acrylamide, N-cyclohexyl acrylamide, higher alkyl amides, where the alkyl group on the nitrogen contains from 8 to 32 carbon atoms, acrylic amides including N-alkylol amides of alpha, beta-olefinically unsaturated carboxylic acids including those having from 4 to 10 carbon atoms such as N-methylol acrylamide, N-propanol acrylamide, N-methylol methacrylamide, N-methylol maleimide, N-methylol maleamic acid esters, N-methylol-p-vinyl benzamide, and the like.
Yet additional useful absorption promoting materials are alpha-olefins containing from 2 to 18 carbon atoms, more preferably from 2 to 8 carbon atoms; dienes containing from 4 to 10 carbon atoms; vinyl esters and allyl esters such as vinyl acetate; vinyl aromatics such as styrene, methyl styrene and chloro-styrene; vinyl and allyl ethers and ketones such as vinyl methyl ether and methyl vinyl ketone; chloroacrylates; cyanoalkyl acrylates such as alpha-cyanomethyl acrylate, and the alpha-, beta-, and gamma-cyanopropyl acrylates; alkoxyacrylates such as methoxy ethyl acrylate; haloacrylates as chloroethyl acrylate; vinyl halides and vinyl chloride, vinylidene chloride and the like; divinyls, diacrylates and other polyfunctional monomers such as divinyl ether, diethylene glycol diacrylate, ethylene glycol dimethacrylate, methylene-bis- acrylamide, allylpentaerythritol, and the like; and bis(beta-haloalkyl) alkenyl phosphonates such as bis(beta-chloroethyl) vinyl phosphonate and the like as are known to those skilled in the art. Copolymers wherein the carboxy containing monomer is a minor constituent, and the other vinylidene monomers present as major components are readily prepared in accordance with the methods disclosed herein.
When hydrogels are employed as absorption promoting agents within the invention, these may be composed of synthetic copolymers from the group of acrylic and methacrylic acids, acrylamide, methacrylamide, hydroxyethylacrylate (HEA) or methacrylate (HEMA), and vinylpyrrolidones which are water interactive and swellable. Specific illustrative examples of useful polymers, especially for the delivery of peptides or proteins, are the following types of polymers: (meth)acrylamide and 0.1 to 99 wt. % (meth)acrylic acid; (meth)acrylamides and 0.1-75 wt % (meth)acryloxyethyl trimethyammonium chloride; (meth)acrylamide and 0.1-75 wt % (meth)acrylamide; acrylic acid and 0.1-75 wt % alkyl(meth)acrylates; (meth)acrylamide and 0.1-75 wt % AMPS.RTM. (trademark of Lubrizol Corp.); (meth)acrylamide and 0 to 30 wt % alkyl(meth)acrylamides and 0.1-75 wt % AMPS.RTM.; (meth)acrylamide and 0.1-99 wt. % HEMA; (metb)acrylamide and 0.1 to 75 wt % HEMA and 0.1 to 99%(meth)acrylic acid; (meth)acrylic acid and 0.1-99 wt % HEMA; 50 mole % vinyl ether and 50 mole % maleic anhydride; (meth)acrylamide and 0.1 to 75 wt % (meth)acryloxyalky dimethyl benzylammonium chloride; (meth)acrylamide and 0.1 to 99 wt % vinyl pyrrolidone; (meth)acrylamide and 50 wt % vinyl pyrrolidone and 0.1-99.9 wt % (meth)acrylic acid; (meth)acrylic acid and 0.1 to 75 wt % AMPS.RTM. and 0.1-75 wt % alkyl(meth)acrylamide. In the above examples, alkyl means C1 to C3o, preferably C1 to C22, linear and branched and C4 to C^ cyclic; where (meth) is used, it means that the monomers with and without the methyl group are included. Other very useful hydrogel polymers are swellable, but insoluble versions of poly(vinyl pyrrolidone) starch, carboxymethyl cellulose and polyvinyl alcohol.
Additional polymeric hydrogel materials useful within the invention include (poly) hydroxyalkyl (meth)acrylate: anionic and cationic hydrogels: poly(electrolyte) complexes; poly(vinyl alcohols) having a low acetate residual: a swellable mixture of crosslinked agar and crosslinked carboxymethyl cellulose: a swellable composition comprising methyl cellulose mixed with a sparingly crosslinked agar; a water swellable copolymer produced by a dispersion of finely divided copolymer of maleic anhydride with styrene, ethylene, propylene, or isobutylene; a water swellable polymer of N-vinyl lactams; swellable sodium salts of carboxymethyl cellulose; and the like. Other gelable, fluid imbibing and retaining polymers useful for forming the hydrophilic hydrogel for mucosal delivery of biologically active agents within the invention include pectin; polysaccharides such as agar, acacia, karaya, tragacenth, algins and guar and their crosslinked versions; acrylic acid polymers, copolymers and salt derivatives, polyacrylamides; water swellable indene maleic anhydride polymers; starch graft copolymers; aery late type polymers and copolymers with water absorbability of about 2 to 400 times its original weight; diesters of polyglucan; a mixture of crosslinked polyvinyl alcohol) and poly(N-vinyl-2-pyrrolidone); polyoxybutylene-polyethylene block copolymer gels; carob gum; polyester gels; poly urea gels; polyether gels; polyamide gels; polyimide gels; polypeptide gels; polyamino acid gels; poly cellulosic gels; crosslinked indene-maleic anhydride acrylate polymers; and polysaccharides. Synthetic hydrogel polymers for use within the invention may be made by an infinite combination of several monomers in several ratios. The hydrogel can be crosslinked and generally possesses the ability to imbibe and absorb fluid and swell or expand to an enlarged equilibrium state. The hydrogel typically swells or expands upon delivery to the nasal mucosal surface, absorbing about 2-5, 5-10, 10-50, up to 50-100 or more times fold its weight of water. The optimum degree of swellability for a given hydrogel will be determined for different biologically active agents depending upon such factors as molecular weight, size, solubility and diffusion characteristics of the active agent carried by or entrapped or encapsulated within the polymer, and the specific spacing and cooperative chain motion associated with each individual polymer. Hydrophilic polymers useful within the invention are water insoluble but water swellable.
Such water-swollen polymers as typically referred to as hydrogels or gels. Such gels may be conveniently produced from water-soluble polymer by the process of crosslinking the polymers by a suitable crosslinking agent. However, stable hydrogels may also be formed from specific polymers under defined conditions of pH, temperature and/or ionic concentration, according to known methods in the art. Typically the polymers are cross-linked to the extent that the polymers possess good hydrophilic properties, have improved physical integrity (as compared to non cross-linked polymers of the same or similar type) and exhibit improved ability to retain within the gel network both the biologically active agent of interest and additional compounds for coadministration therewith such as a cytokine or enzyme inhibitor, while retaining the ability to release the active agent(s) at the appropriate location and time.
Generally hydrogel polymers for use within the invention are crosslinked with a difunctional cross-linking in the amount of from 0.01 to 25 weight percent, based on the weight of the monomers forming the copolymer, and more preferably from 0.1 to 20 weight percent and more often from 0.1 to 15 weight percent of the crosslinking agent. Another useful amount of a crosslinking agent is 0.1 to 10 weight percent. Tri, tetra or higher multifunctional crosslinking agents may also be employed. When such reagents are utilized, lower amounts may be required to attain equivalent crosslinking density, i.e., the degree of crosslinking, or network properties that are sufficient to contain effectively the biologically active agent(s).
The crosslinks can be covalent, ionic or hydrogen bonds with the polymer possessing the ability to swell in the presence of water containing fluids. Such crosslinkers and crosslinking reactions are known to those skilled in the art and in many cases are dependent upon the polymer system. Thus a crosslinked network may be formed by free radical copolymerization of unsaturated monomers. Polymeric hydrogels may also be formed by crosslinking preformed polymers by reacting functional groups found on the polymers such as alcohols, acids, amines with such groups as glyoxal, formaldehyde or glutaraldehyde, bis anhydrides and the like. The polymers also may be cross-linked with any polyene, e.g. decadiene or trivinyl cyclohexane; acrylamides, such as N,N-methylene-bis (acrylamide); polyfunctional acrylates, such as trimethylol propane triacrylate; or polyfunctional vinylidene monomer containing at least 2 terminal CH2 < groups, including, for example, divinyl benzene, divinyl naphthlene, allyl acrylates and the like. In certain embodiments, cross-linking monomers for use in preparing the copolymers are polyalkenyl polyethers having more than one alkenyl ether grouping per molecule, which may optionally possess alkenyl groups in which an olefinic double bond is present attached to a terminal methylene grouping (e.g., made by the etherification of a polyhydric alcohol containing at least 2 carbon atoms and at least 2 hydroxyl groups). Compounds of this class may be produced by reacting an alkenyl halide, such as allyl chloride or allyl bromide, with a strongly alkaline aqueous solution of one or more polyhydric alcohols. The product may be a complex mixture of polyethers with varying numbers of ether groups. Efficiency of the polyether cross-linking agent increases with the number of potentially polymerizable groups on the molecule. Typically, polyethers containing an average of two or more alkenyl ether groupings per molecule are used. Other cross-linking monomers include for example, diallyl esters, dimethallyl ethers, allyl or methallyl acrylates and acrylamides, tetravinyl silane, polyalkenyl methanes, diacrylates, and dimethacrylates, divinyl compounds such as divinyl benzene, polyallyl phosphate, diallyloxy compounds and phosphite esters and the like. Typical agents are allyl pentaerythritol, allyl sucrose, trimethylolpropane triacrylate, 1,6-hexanediol diacrylate, trimethylolpropane diallyl ether, pentaerythritol triacrylate, tetramethylene dimethacrylate, ethylene diacrylate, ethylene dimethacrylate, triethylene glycol dimethacrylate, and the like. Allyl pentaerythritol, trimethylolpropane diallylether and allyl sucrose provide suitable polymers. When the cross-linking agent is present, the polymeric mixtures usually contain between about 0.01 to 20 weight percent, e.g., 1%, 5%, or 10% or more
4o ϊftarwϊϊϊSiϊ^fiS^WBΪSEi'irassmϋiiw, by weight of cross-linking monomer based on the total of carboxylic acid monomer, plus other monomers.
In more detailed aspects of the invention, mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein, is enhanced by retaining the active agent(s) in a slow-release or enzymatically or physiologically protective carrier or vehicle, for example a hydrogel that shields the active agent from the action of the degradative enzymes. In certain embodiments, the active agent is bound by chemical means to the carrier or vehicle, to which may also be admixed or bound additional agents such as enzyme inhibitors, cytokines, etc. The active agent may alternately be immobilized through sufficient physical entrapment within the carrier or vehicle, e.g., a polymer matrix. Polymers such as hydrogels useful within the invention may incorporate functional linked agents such as glycosides chemically incorporated into the polymer for enhancing intranasal bioavailability of active agents formulated therewith. Examples of such glycosides are glucosides, fructosides, galactosides, arabinosides, mannosides and their alkyl substituted derivatives and natural glycosides such as arbutin, phlorizin, amygdalin, digitonin, saponin, and indican. There are several ways in which a typical glycoside may be bound to a polymer. For example, the hydrogen of the hydroxyl groups of a glycoside or other similar carbohydrate may be replaced by the alkyl group from a hydrogel polymer to form an ether. Also, the hydroxyl groups of the glycosides may be reacted to esterify the carboxyl groups of a polymeric hydrogel to form polymeric esters in situ. Another approach is to employ condensation of acetobromoglucose with cholest-5-en-3beta-ol on a copolymer of maleic acid. N-substituted polyacrylamides can be synthesized by the reaction of activated polymers with omega- aminoalkylglycosides: (1) (carbohydrate-spacer)(n)-polyacrylamide, 'pseudopolysaccharides'; (2) (carbohydrate spacer)(n)-phosphatidylethanolamine(m)-polyacrylamide, neoglycolipids, derivatives of phosphatidylethanolamine; (3) (carbohydrate-spacer)(n)-biotin(m)- polyacrylamide. These biotinylated derivatives may attach to lectins on the mucosal surface to facilitate absorption of the biologically active agent(s), e.g., a polymer-encapsulated glucose- regulating peptide.
Within more detailed aspects of the invention, one or more glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and/or other biologically active agents, disclosed herein, optionally including secondary active agents such as protease inhibitor(s), cytokine(s), additional modulator(s) of intercellular junctional physiology, etc., are modified and bound to a polymeric carrier or matrix. For example, this may be accomplished by chemically binding a peptide or protein active agent and other optional agent(s) within a crosslinked polymer network. It is also possible to chemically modify the polymer separately with an interactive agent such as a
41
Mmfflmrnmmmmia glycosidal containing molecule. In certain aspects, the biologically active agent(s), and optional secondary active agent(s), may be functionalized, i.e., wherein an appropriate reactive group is identified or is chemically added to the active agent(s). Most often an ethylenic polymerizable group is added, and the functionalized active agent is then copolymerized with monomers and a crosslmking agent using a standard polymerization method such as solution polymerization (usually in water), emulsion, suspension or dispersion polymerization. Often, the functionalizing agent is provided with a high enough concentration of functional or polymerizable groups to insure that several sites on the active agent(s) are functionalized. For example, in a polypeptide comprising 16 amine sites, it is generally desired to functionalize at least 2, 4, 5, 7, and up to 8 or more of the sites. After functionalization, the functionalized active agent(s) is/are mixed with monomers and a crosslmking agent that comprise the reagents from which the polymer of interest is formed. Polymerization is then induced in this medium to create a polymer containing the bound active agent(s). The polymer is then combined with water or other appropriate solvents and otherwise purified to remove trace unreacted impurities and, if necessary, ground or broken up by physical means such as by stirring, forcing it through a mesh, ultrasonication or other suitable means to a desired particle size. The solvent, usually water, is then removed in such a manner as to not denature or otherwise degrade the active agent(s). One desired method is lyophilization (freeze drying) but other methods are available and may be used (e.g., vacuum drying, air drying, spray drying, etc.). To introduce polymerizable groups in peptides, proteins and other active agents within the invention, it is possible to react available amino, hydroxyl, thiol and other reactive groups with electrophiles containing unsaturated groups. For example, unsaturated monomers containing N-hydroxy succinimidyl groups, active carbonates such as p-nitrophenyl carbonate, trichlorophenyl carbonates, tresylate, oxycarbonylimidazoles, epoxide, isocyanates and aldehyde, and unsaturated carboxymethyl azides and unsaturated orthopyridyl-disulfide belong to this category of reagents. Illustrative examples of unsaturated reagents are allyl glycidyl ether, allyl chloride, allylbromide, allyl iodide, acryloyl chloride, allyl isocyanate, allylsulfonyl chloride, maleic anhydride, copolymers of maleic anhydride and allyl ether, and the like.
All of the lysine active derivatives, except aldehyde, can generally react with other amino acids such as imidazole groups of histidine and hydroxyl groups of tyrosine and the thiol groups of cystine if the local environment enhances nucleophilicity of these groups. Aldehyde containing functionalizing reagents are specific to lysine. These types of reactions with available groups from lysines, cysteines, tyrosine have been extensively documented in the literature and are known to those skilled in the art. In the case of biologically active agents that contain amine groups, it is convenient to react such groups with an acyloyl chloride, such as acryloyl chloride, and introduce the polymerizable acrylic group onto the reacted agent. Then during preparation of the polymer, such as during the crosslinking of the copolymer of acrylamide and acrylic acid, the functionalized active agent, through the acrylic groups, is attached to the polymer and becomes bound thereto.
In additional aspects of the invention, biologically active agents, including peptides, proteins, nucleosides, and other molecules which are bioactive in vivo, are conjugation-stabilized by covalently bonding one or more active agent(s) to a polymer incorporating as an integral part thereof both a hydrophilic moiety, e.g., a linear polyalkylene glycol, a lipophilic moiety (see, e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,681,811). In one aspect, a biologically active agent is covalently coupled with a polymer comprising (i) a linear polyalkylene glycol moiety, and (ii) a lipophilic moiety, wherein the active agent, linear polyalkylene glycol moiety, and the lipophilic moiety are conformationally arranged in relation to one another such that the active therapeutic agent has an enhanced in vivo resistance to enzymatic degradation (i.e., relative to its stability under similar conditions in an unconjugated form devoid of the polymer coupled thereto). In another aspect, the conjugation-stabilized formulation has a three-dimensional conformation comprising the biologically active agent covalently coupled with a polysorbate complex comprising (i) a linear polyalkylene glycol moiety, and (ii) a lipophilic moiety, wherein the active agent, the linear polyalkylene glycol moiety and the lipophilic moiety are conformationally arranged in relation to one another such that (a) the lipophilic moiety is exteriorly available in the three-dimensional conformation, and (b) the active agent in the composition has an enhanced in vivo resistance to enzymatic degradation.
In a further related aspect, a multiligand conjugated complex is provided which comprises a biologically active agent covalently coupled with a triglyceride backbone moiety through a polyalkylene glycol spacer group bonded at a carbon atom of the triglyceride backbone moiety, and at least one fatty acid moiety covalently attached either directly to a carbon atom of the triglyceride backbone moiety or covalently joined through a polyalkylene glycol spacer moiety (see, e.g., U.S. Patent No. 5,681,811). In such a multiligand conjugated therapeutic agent complex, the alpha' and beta carbon atoms of the triglyceride bioactive moiety may have fatty acid moieties attached by covalently bonding either directly thereto, or indirectly covalently bonded thereto through polyalkylene glycol spacer moieties. Alternatively, a fatty acid moiety may be covalently attached either directly or through a polyalkylene glycol spacer moiety to the alpha and alpha' carbons of the triglyceride backbone moiety, with the bioactive therapeutic agent being covalently coupled with the gamma-carbon of the triglyceride backbone moiety, either being directly covalently bonded thereto or indirectly bonded thereto through a polyalkylene spacer moiety. It will be recognized that a wide variety of structural, compositional, and conformational forms are possible for the multiligand conjugated therapeutic agent complex comprising the triglyceride backbone moiety, within the scope of the invention. It is further noted that in such a multiligand conjugated therapeutic agent complex, the biologically active agent(s) may advantageously be covalently coupled with the triglyceride modified backbone moiety through alkyl spacer groups, or alternatively other acceptable spacer groups, within the scope of the invention. As used in such context, acceptability of the spacer group refers to steric, compositional, and end use application specific acceptability characteristics. In yet additional aspects of the invention, a conjugation-stabilized complex is provided which comprises a polysorbate complex comprising a polysorbate moiety including a triglyceride backbone having covalently coupled to alpha, alpha1 and beta carbon atoms thereof functionalizing groups including (i) a fatty acid group; and (ii) a polyethylene glycol group having a biologically active agent or moiety covalently bonded thereto, e.g., bonded to an appropriate functionality of the polyethylene glycol group. Such covalent bonding may be either direct, e.g., to a hydroxy terminal functionality of the polyethylene glycol group, or alternatively, the covalent bonding may be indirect, e.g., by reactively capping the hydroxy terminus of the polyethylene glycol group with a terminal carboxy functionality spacer group, so that the resulting capped polyethylene glycol group has a terminal carboxy functionality to which the biologically active agent or moiety may be covalently bonded.
In yet additional aspects of the invention, a stable, aqueously soluble, conjugation- stabilized complex is provided which comprises one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and/or other biologically active agent(s)+ disclosed herein covalently coupled to a physiologically compatible polyethylene glycol (PEG) modified glycolipid moiety. In such complex, the biologically active agent(s) may be covalently coupled to the physiologically compatible PEG modified glycolipid moiety by a labile covalent bond at a free amino acid group of the active agent, wherein the labile covalent bond is scissionable in vivo by biochemical hydrolysis and/or proteolysis. The physiologically compatible PEG modified glycolipid moiety may advantageously comprise a polysorbate polymer, e.g., a polysorbate polymer comprising fatty acid ester groups selected from the group consisting of monopalmitate, dipalmitate, monolaurate, dilaurate, trilaurate, monoleate, dioleate, trioleate, monostearate, distearate, and tristearate. In such complex, the physiologically compatible PEG modified glycolipid moiety may suitably comprise a polymer selected from the group consisting of polyethylene glycol ethers of fatty acids, and polyethylene glycol esters of fatty acids, wherein the fatty acids for example comprise a fatty acid selected from the group consisting of lauric, palmitic, oleic, and stearic acids.
Manufacture
The nasal spray product manufacturing process generally includes the preparation of a diluent for glucose-regulating peptide nasal spray, which includes ~85% water plus the components of the nasal spray formulation without glucose-regulating peptide. The pH of the diluent is then measured and adjusted with sodium hydroxide or hydrochloric acid, if necessary. The glucose-regulating peptide nasal spray is prepared by the non-aseptic transfer of ~85% of the final target volume of the diluent to a screw cap bottle. An appropriate amount of glucose- regulating peptide is added and mixed until completely dissolved. The pH is measured and adjusted with sodium hydroxide or hydrochloric acid, if necessary. A sufficient quantity of diluent is added to reach the final target volume. Screw-cap bottles are filled and caps affixed. The above description of the manufacturing process represents a method used to prepare the initial clinical batches of drug product. This method may be modified during the development process to optimize the manufacturing process. Parenteral administration, including glucose-regulating peptide for injection or infusion, requires a sterile (aseptic) manufacturing process compliance with FDA regulations. Current Good Manufacturing Practices (GMP) for sterile drug manufacturing include standards for design and construction features (21 C.F.R. § 211.42 (April 1, 2005)); standards for testing and approval or rejection of components, drug product containers, and closures (§ 211.84); standards for control of microbiological contamination (§ 211.113); and other special testing requirements (§ 211.167). Non-parenteral (non-aseptic) products, such as the intranasal product of the invention, do not require these specialized sterile manufacturing conditions. As can be readily appreciated, the requirements for a sterile manufacturing process are substantially higher and correspondingly more costly than those required for a non-sterile product manufacturing process. These costs include much greater capitalization costs for facilities, as well as a more costly manufacturing cost: extra facilites for sterile manufacturing include additional rooms and ventilation; extra costs associated with sterile manufacturing include greater manpower, extensive quality control and quality assurance, and administrative support. As a result, manufacturing costs of an intranasal glucose-regulating peptide product, such as that of the invention, are far less than those of a parenterally administered glucose-regulating peptide product. The present invention satisfies the need for a non-sterile manufacturing process for glucose-regulating peptides.
45 ι!BΪ>iSS*ϊ»i!SSiϋϊ«i*S«ϊilHiϊJ»r*wa Sterile solutions can be prepared by incorporating the active compound in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filtered sterilization. Generally, dispersions are prepared by incorporating the active compound into a sterile vehicle that contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above. In the case of sterile powders, methods of preparation include vacuum drying and freeze-drying which yields a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof. The prevention of the action of microorganisms can be accomplished by various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, sorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like.
Storage of Material
In certain aspects of the invention, the combinatorial formulations and/or coordinate administration methods herein incorporate an effective amount of peptides and proteins which may adhere to charged glass thereby reducing the effective concentration in the container. Silanized containers, for example, silanized glass containers, are used to store the finished product to reduce adsorption of the polypeptide or protein to a glass container.
In yet additional aspects of the invention, a kit for treatment of a mammalian subject comprises a stable pharmaceutical composition of one or more glucose-regulating peptide compound(s) formulated for mucosal delivery to the mammalian subject wherein the composition is effective to alleviate one or more symptom(s) of diabetes, obesity, cancer,hyperglycemia, dyslipidemia, metabolic syndrome, coronary syndrome, myocardial infraction, or neurological disorder in said subject without unacceptable adverse side effects. The kit further comprises a pharmaceutical reagent vial to contain the one or more glucose- regulating peptide compounds. The pharmaceutical reagent vial is composed of pharmaceutical grade polymer, glass or other suitable material. The pharmaceutical reagent vial is, for example, a silanized glass vial. The kit further comprises an aperture for delivery of the composition to a nasal mucosal surface of the subject. The delivery aperture is composed of a pharmaceutical grade polymer, glass or other suitable material. The delivery aperture is, for example, a silanized glass.
A silanization technique combines a special cleaning technique for the surfaces to be silanized with a silanization process at low pressure. The silane is in the gas phase and at an enhanced temperature of the surfaces to be silanized. The method provides reproducible surfaces with stable, homogeneous and functional silane layers having characteristics of a monolayer. The silanized surfaces prevent binding to the glass of polypeptides or mucosal delivery enhancing agents of the present invention.
The procedure is useful to prepare silanized pharmaceutical reagent vials to hold glucose- regulating peptide compositions of the present invention. Glass trays are cleaned by rinsing with double distilled water (ddH2O) before using. The silane tray is then be rinsed with 95% EtOH, and the acetone tray is rinsed with acetone. Pharmaceutical reagent vials are sonicated in acetone for 10 minutes. After the acetone sonication, reagent vials are ished in ddH2O tray at least twice. Reagent vials are sonicated in 0.1M NaOH for 10 minutes. While the reagent vials are sonicating in NaOH, the silane solution is made under a hood. (Silane solution: 800 mL of 95% ethanol; 96 L of glacial acetic acid; 25 mL of glycidoxypropyltrimethoxy silane). After the NaOH sonication, reagent vials are ished in ddH2O tray at least twice. The reagent vials are sonicated in silane solution for 3 to 5 minutes. The reagent vials are ished in 100% EtOH tray. The reagent vials are dried with prepurified N2 gas and stored in a 100°C oven for at least 2 hours before using.
Bioadhesive Delivery Vehicles and Methods In certain aspects of the invention, the combinatorial formulations and/or coordinate administration methods herein incorporate an effective amount of a nontoxic bioadhesive as an adjunct compound or carrier to enhance mucosal delivery of one or more biologically active agent(s). Bioadhesive agents in this context exhibit general or specific adhesion to one or more components or surfaces of the targeted mucosa. The bioadhesive maintains a desired concentration gradient of the biologically active agent into or across the mucosa to ensure penetration of even large molecules (e.g., peptides and proteins) into or through the mucosal epithelium. Typically, employment of a bioadhesive within the methods and compositions of the invention yields a two- to five-fold, often a five- to ten-fold increase in permeability for peptides and proteins into or through the mucosal epithelium. This enhancement of epithelial permeation often permits effective transmucosal delivery of large macromolecules, for example to the basal portion of the nasal epithelium or into the adjacent extracellular compartments or a blood plasma or CNS tissue or fluid.
This enhanced delivery provides for greatly improved effectiveness of delivery of bioactive peptides, proteins and other macromolecular therapeutic species. These results will depend in part on the hydrophilicity of the compound, whereby greater penetration will be achieved with hydrophilic species compared to water insoluble compounds. In addition to these effects, employment of bioadhesives to enhance drug persistence at the mucosal surface can elicit a reservoir mechanism for protracted drug delivery, whereby compounds not only penetrate across the mucosal tissue but also back-diffuse toward the mucosal surface once the material at the surface is depleted.
A variety of suitable bioadhesives are disclosed in the art for oral administration, U.S. Patent Nos. 3,972,995; 4,259,314; 4,680,323; 4,740,365; 4,573,996; 4,292,299; 4,715,369; 4,876,092; 4,855,142; 4,250,163; 4,226,848; 4,948,580; U.S. Patent Reissue No. 33,093, which find use within the novel methods and compositions of the invention. The potential of various bioadhesive polymers as a mucosal, e.g., nasal, delivery platform within the methods and compositions of the invention can be readily assessed by determining their ability to retain and release glucose-regulating peptide, as well as by their capacity to interact with the mucosal surfaces following incorporation of the active agent therein. In addition, well known methods will be applied to determine the biocompatibility of selected polymers with the tissue at the site of mucosal administration. When the target mucosa is covered by mucus (i.e., in the absence of mucolytic or mucus-clearing treatment), it can serve as a connecting link to the underlying mucosal epithelium. Therefore, the term "bioadhesive" as used herein also covers mucoadhesive compounds useful for enhancing mucosal delivery of biologically active agents within the invention. However, adhesive contact to mucosal tissue mediated through adhesion to a mucus gel layer may be limited by incomplete or transient attachment between the mucus layer and the underlying tissue, particularly at nasal surfaces where rapid mucus clearance occurs. In this regard, mucin glycoproteins are continuously secreted and, immediately after their release from cells or glands, form a viscoelastic gel. The luminal surface of the adherent gel layer, however, is continuously eroded by mechanical, enzymatic and/or ciliary action. Where such activities are more prominent or where longer adhesion times are desired, the coordinate administration methods and combinatorial formulation methods of the invention may further incorporate mucolytic and/or ciliostatic methods or agents as disclosed herein above.
Typically, mucoadhesive polymers for use within the invention are natural or synthetic macromolecules which adhere to wet mucosal tissue surfaces by complex, but non-specific, mechanisms. In addition to these mucoadhesive polymers, the invention also provides methods and compositions incorporating bioadhesives that adhere directly to a cell surface, rather than to mucus, by means of specific, including receptor-mediated, interactions. One example of bioadhesives that function in this specific manner is the group of compounds known as lectins. These are glycoproteins with an ability to specifically recognize and bind to sugar molecules, e.g., glycoproteins or glycolipids, which form part of intranasal epithelial cell membranes and can be considered as "lectin receptors".
In certain aspects of the invention, bioadhesive materials for enhancing intranasal delivery of biologically active agents comprise a matrix of a hydrophilic, e.g., water soluble or swellable, polymer or a mixture of polymers that can adhere to a wet mucous surface. These adhesives may be formulated as ointments, hydrogels (see above) thin films, and other application forms. Often, these adhesives have the biologically active agent mixed therewith to effectuate slow release or local delivery of the active agent. Some are formulated with additional ingredients to facilitate penetration of the active agent through the nasal mucosa, e.g., into the circulatory system of the individual.
Various polymers, both natural and synthetic ones, show significant binding to mucus and/or mucosal epithelial surfaces under physiological conditions. The strength of this interaction can readily be measured by mechanical peel or shear tests. When applied to a humid mucosal surface, many dry materials will spontaneously adhere, at least slightly. After such an initial contact, some hydrophilic materials start to attract water by adsorption, swelling or capillary forces, and if this water is absorbed from the underlying substrate or from the polymer- tissue interface, the adhesion may be sufficient to achieve the goal of enhancing mucosal absorption of biologically active agents. Such 'adhesion by hydration' can be quite strong, but formulations adapted to employ this mechanism must account for swelling which continues as the dosage transforms into a hydrated mucilage. This is projected for many hydrocolloids useful within the invention, especially some cellulose-derivatives, which are generally non-adhesive when applied in pre-hydrated state. Nevertheless, bioadhesive drug delivery systems for mucosal administration are effective within the invention when such materials are applied in the form of a dry polymeric powder, microsphere, or film-type delivery form. Other polymers adhere to mucosal surfaces not only when applied in dry, but also in fully hydrated state, and in the presence of excess amounts of water. The selection of a mucoadhesive thus requires due consideration of the conditions, physiological as well as physico-chemical, under which the contact to the tissue will be formed and maintained. In particular, the amount of water or humidity usually present at the intended site of adhesion, and the prevailing pH, are known to largely affect the mucoadhesive binding strength of different polymers.
Several polymeric bioadhesive drug delivery systems have been fabricated and studied in the past 20 years, not always with success. A variety of such carriers are, however, currently used in clinical applications involving dental, orthopedic, ophthalmological, and surgical uses. For example, acrylic-based hydrogels have been used extensively for bioadhesive devices. Acrylic-based hydrogels are well suited for bioadhesion due to their flexibility and nonabrasive characteristics in the partially swollen state, which reduce damage-causing attrition to the tissues in contact. Furthermore, their high permeability in the swollen state allows unreacted monomer, un-crosslinked polymer chains, and the initiator to be ished out of the matrix after polymerization, which is an important feature for selection of bioadhesive materials for use within the invention. Acrylic-based polymer devices exhibit very high adhesive bond strength. For controlled mucosal delivery of peptide and protein drugs, the methods and compositions of the invention optionally include the use of carriers, e.g., polymeric delivery vehicles, that function in part to shield the biologically active agent from proteolytic breakdown, while at the same time providing for enhanced penetration of the peptide or protein into or through the nasal mucosa. In this context, bioadhesive polymers have demonstrated considerable potential for enhancing oral drug delivery. As an example, the bioavailability of 9-desglycinamide, 8-arginine vasopressin (DGAVP) intraduodenally administered to rats together with a 1% (w/v) saline dispersion of the mucoadhesive poly(acrylic acid) derivative polycarbophil, is 3-5-fold increased compared to an aqueous solution of the peptide drug without this polymer. Mucoadhesive polymers of the poly(acrylic acid)-type are potent inhibitors of some intestinal proteases. The mechanism of enzyme inhibition is explained by the strong affinity of this class of polymers for divalent cations, such as calcium or zinc, which are essential cofactors of metallo-proteinases, such as trypsin and chymotrypsin. Depriving the proteases of their cofactors by poly(acrylic acid) is reported to induce irreversible structural changes of the enzyme proteins which were accompanied by a loss of enzyme activity. At the same time, other mucoadhesive polymers (e.g., some cellulose derivatives and chitosan) may not inhibit proteolytic enzymes under certain conditions. In contrast to other enzyme inhibitors contemplated for use within the invention (e.g., aprotinin, bestatin), which are relatively small molecules, the trans-nasal absorption of inhibitory polymers is likely to be minimal in light of the size of these molecules, and thereby eliminate possible adverse side effects. Thus, mucoadhesive polymers, particularly of the poly(acrylic acid)-type, may serve both as an absorption-promoting adhesive and enzyme-protective agent to enhance controlled delivery of peptide and protein drugs, especially when safety concerns are considered.
In addition to protecting against enzymatic degradation, bioadhesives and other polymeric or non-polymeric absorption-promoting agents for use within the invention may directly increase mucosal permeability to biologically active agents. To facilitate the transport of large and hydrophilic molecules, such as peptides and proteins, across the nasal epithelial barrier, mucoadhesive polymers and other agents have been postulated to yield enhanced permeation effects beyond what is accounted for by prolonged premucosal residence time of the delivery system. The time course of drug plasma concentrations reportedly suggested that the bioadhesive microspheres caused an acute, but transient increase of insulin permeability across the nasal mucosa. Other mucoadhesive polymers for use within the invention, for example chitosan, reportedly enhance the permeability of certain mucosal epithelia even when they are applied as an aqueous solution or gel. Another mucoadhesive polymer reported to directly affect epithelial permeability is hyaluronic acid and ester derivatives thereof. A particularly useful bioadhesive agent within the coordinate administration, and/or combinatorial formulation methods and compositions of the invention is chitosan, as well as its analogs and derivatives. Chitosan is a non-toxic, biocompatible and biodegradable polymer that is widely used for pharmaceutical and medical applications because of its favorable properties of low toxicity and good biocompatibility. It is a natural polyaminosaccharide prepared from chitin by
N-deacetylation with alkali. As used within the methods and compositions of the invention, chitosan increases the retention of glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein at a mucosal site of application. This mode of administration can also improve patient compliance and acceptance. As further provided herein, the methods and compositions of the invention will optionally include a novel chitosan derivative or chemically modified form of chitosan. One such novel derivative for use within the invention is denoted as a β-[l-»4]-2-guanidino-2-deoxy-D-glucose polymer (poly-GuD). Chitosan is the N-deacetylated product of chitin, a naturally occurring polymer that has been used extensively to prepare microspheres for oral and intra-nasal formulations. The chitosan polymer has also been proposed as a soluble carrier for parenteral drug delivery. Within one aspect of the invention, o-methylisourea is used to convert a chitosan amine to its guanidinium moiety. The guanidinium compound is prepared, for example, by the reaction between equi-normal solutions of chitosan and o-methylisourea atpH above 8.0.
Additional compounds classified as bioadhesive agents for use within the present invention act by mediating specific interactions, typically classified as "receptor-ligand interactions" between complementary structures of the bioadhesive compound and a component of the mucosal epithelial surface. Many natural examples illustrate this form of specific binding bioadhesion, as exemplified by lectin-sugar interactions. Lectins are (glyco) proteins of non-immune origin which bind to polysaccharides or glycoconjugates. Several plant lectins have been investigated as possible pharmaceutical absorption- promoting agents. One plant lectin, Phaseolus vulgaris hemagglutinin (PHA), exhibits high oral bioavailability of more than 10% after feeding to rats. Tomato (Lycopersicon esculeutum) lectin (TL) appears safe for various modes of administration.
In summary, the foregoing bioadhesive agents are useful in the combinatorial formulations and coordinate administration methods of the instant invention, which optionally incorporate an effective amount and form of a bioadhesive agent to prolong persistence or otherwise increase mucosal absorption of one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents. The bioadhesive agents may be coordinately administered as adjunct compounds or as additives within the combinatorial formulations of the invention. In certain embodiments, the bioadhesive agent acts as a 'pharmaceutical glue,' whereas in other embodiments adjunct delivery or combinatorial formulation of the bioadhesive agent serves to intensify contact of the biologically active agent with the nasal mucosa, in some cases by promoting specific receptor-ligand interactions with epithelial cell "receptors," and in others by increasing epithelial permeability to significantly increase the drug concentration gradient measured at a target site of delivery (e.g., liver, blood plasma, or CNS tissue or fluid). Yet additional bioadhesive agents for use within the invention act as enzyme (e.g., protease) inhibitors to enhance the stability of mucosally administered biotherapeutic agents delivered coordinately or in a combinatorial formulation with the bioadhesive agent.
Liposomes and Micellar Delivery Vehicles
The coordinate administration methods and combinatorial formulations of the instant invention optionally incorporate effective lipid or fatty acid based carriers, processing agents, or delivery vehicles, to provide improved formulations for mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents. For example, a variety of formulations and methods are provided for mucosal delivery which comprise one or more of these active agents, such as a peptide or protein, admixed or encapsulated by, or coordinately administered with, a liposome, mixed micellar carrier, or emulsion, to enhance chemical and physical stability and increase the half life of the biologically active agents (e.g., by reducing susceptibility to proteolysis, chemical modification and/or denaturation) upon mucosal delivery.
Within certain aspects of the invention, specialized delivery systems for biologically active agents comprise small lipid vesicles known as liposomes. These are typically made from natural, biodegradable, non-toxic, and non-immunogenic lipid molecules, and can efficiently entrap or bind drug molecules, including peptides and proteins, into, or onto, their membranes. The attractiveness of liposomes as a peptide and protein delivery system within the invention is increased by the fact that the encapsulated proteins can remain in their preferred aqueous environment within the vesicles, while the liposomal membrane protects them against proteolysis and other destabilizing factors. Even though not all liposome preparation methods known are feasible in the encapsulation of peptides and proteins due to their unique physical and chemical properties, several methods allow the encapsulation of these macromolecules without substantial deactivation.
A variety of methods are available for preparing liposomes for use within the invention, U.S. Patent Nos. 4,235,871; 4,501,728; and 4,837,028. For use with liposome delivery, the biologically active agent is typically entrapped within the liposome, or lipid vesicle, or is bound to the outside of the vesicle.
Like liposomes, unsaturated long chain fatty acids, which also have enhancing activity for mucosal absorption, can form closed vesicles with bilayer-like structures (so called "ufasomes"). These can be formed, for example, using oleic acid to entrap biologically active peptides and proteins for mucosal, e.g., intranasal, delivery within the invention.
Other delivery systems for use within the invention combine the use of polymers and liposomes to ally the advantageous properties of both vehicles such as encapsulation inside the natural polymer fibrin. In addition, release of biotherapeutic compounds from this delivery system is controllable through the use of covalent crosslinking and the addition of antifibrinolytic agents to the fibrin polymer.
More simplified delivery systems for use within the invention include the use of cationic lipids as delivery vehicles or carriers, which can be effectively employed to provide an electrostatic interaction between the lipid carrier and such charged biologically active agents as proteins and polyanionic nucleic acids. This allows efficient packaging of the drugs into a form suitable for mucosal administration and/or subsequent delivery to systemic compartments.
Additional delivery vehicles for use within the invention include long and medium chain fatty acids, as well as surfactant mixed micelles with fatty acids. Most naturally occurring lipids in the form of esters have important implications with regard to their own transport across mucosal surfaces. Free fatty acids and their monoglycerides which have polar groups attached have been demonstrated in the form of mixed micelles to act on the intestinal barrier as penetration enhancers. This discovery of barrier modifying function of free fatty acids (carboxylic acids with a chain length varying from 12 to 20 carbon atoms) and their polar derivatives has stimulated extensive research on the application of these agents as mucosal absorption enhancers. For use within the methods of the invention, long chain fatty acids, especially fusogenic lipids (unsaturated fatty acids and monoglycerides such as oleic acid, linoleic acid, linoleic acid, monoolein, etc.) provide useful carriers to enhance mucosal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein. Medium chain fatty acids (C6 to C 12) and monoglycerides have also been shown to have enhancing activity in intestinal drug absorption and can be adapted for use within the mocosal delivery formulations and methods of the invention. In addition, sodium salts of medium and long chain fatty acids are effective delivery vehicles and absorption-enhancing agents for mucosal delivery of biologically active agents within the invention. Thus, fatty acids can be employed in soluble forms of sodium salts or by the addition of non-toxic surfactants, e.g., polyoxyethylated hydrogenated castor oil, sodium taurocholate, etc. Other fatty acid and mixed micellar preparations that are useful within the invention include, but are not limited to, Na caprylate (C8), Na caprate (ClO), Na laurate (C12) or Na oleate (Cl 8), optionally combined with bile salts, such as glycocholate and taurocholate.
Pegylation Additional methods and compositions provided within the invention involve chemical modification of biologically active peptides and proteins by covalent attachment of polymeric materials, for example dextrans, polyvinyl pyrrolidones, glycopeptides, polyethylene glycol and polyamino acids. The resulting conjugated peptides and proteins retain their biological activities and solubility for mucosal administration. In alternate embodiments, glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active peptides and proteins, are conjugated to polyalkylene oxide polymers, particularly polyethylene glycols (PEG). U.S. Patent No. 4,179,337.
Amine-reactive PEG polymers for use within the invention include SC-PEG with molecular masses of 2000, 5000, 10000, 12000, and 20000; U-PEG-10000; NHS-PEG-3400- biotin; T-PEG-5000; T-PEG-12000; and TPC-PEG-5000. PEGylation of biologically active peptides and proteins may be achieved by modification of carboxyl sites (e.g., aspartic acid or glutamic acid groups in addition to the carboxyl terminus). The utility of PEG-hydrazide in selective modification of carbodiimide-activated protein carboxyl groups under acidic conditions has been described. Alternatively, bifunctional PEG modification of biologically active peptides and proteins can be employed. In some procedures, charged amino acid residues, including lysine, aspartic acid, and glutamic acid, have a marked tendency to be solvent accessible on protein surfaces.
Other Stabilizing Modifications of Active Agents
In addition to PEGylation, biologically active agents such as peptides and proteins for use within the invention can be modified to enhance circulating half-life by shielding the active agent via conjugation to other known protecting or stabilizing compounds, for example by the creation of fusion proteins with an active peptide, protein, analog or mimetic linked to one or more carrier proteins, such as one or more immunoglobulin chains.
Formulation and Administration Mucosal delivery formulations of the present invention comprise glucose-regulating peptide, analogs and mimetics, typically combined together with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers and, optionally, other therapeutic ingredients. The carrier(s) must be "pharmaceutically acceptable" in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not eliciting an unacceptable deleterious effect in the subject. Such carriers are described herein above or are otherwise well known to those skilled in the art of pharmacology. Desirably, the formulation should not include substances such as enzymes or oxidizing agents with which the biologically active agent to be administered is known to be incompatible. The formulations may be prepared by any of the methods well known in the art of pharmacy.
Within the compositions and methods of the invention, the glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein may be administered to subjects by a variety of mucosal administration modes, including by oral, rectal, vaginal, intranasal, intrapulmonary, or transdermal delivery, or by topical delivery to the eyes, ears, skin or other mucosal surfaces. Optionally, glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs and mimetics, and other biologically active agents disclosed herein can be coordinately or adjunctively administered by non-mucosal routes, including by intramuscular, subcutaneous, intravenous, intra-atrial, intra-articular, intraperitoneal, or parenteral routes. In other alternative embodiments, the biologically active agent(s) can be administered ex vivo by direct exposure to cells, tissues or organs originating from a mammalian subject, for example as a component of an ex vivo tissue or organ treatment formulation that contains the biologically active agent in a suitable, liquid or solid carrier.
Compositions according to the present invention are often administered in an aqueous solution as a nasal or pulmonary spray and may be dispensed in spray form by a variety of methods known to those skilled in the art. Preferred systems for dispensing liquids as a nasal spray are disclosed in U.S. Patent No. 4,511,069. The formulations may be presented in multi- dose containers, for example in the sealed dispensing system disclosed in U.S. Patent No. 4,511,069. Additional aerosol delivery forms may include, e.g., compressed air-, jet-, ultrasonic-, and piezoelectric nebulizers, which deliver the biologically active agent dissolved or suspended in a pharmaceutical solvent, e.g., water, ethanol, or a mixture thereof.
Nasal and pulmonary spray solutions of the present invention typically comprise the drug or drug to be delivered, optionally formulated with a surface-active agent, such as a nonionic surfactant (e.g., polysorbate-80), and one or more buffers. In some embodiments of the present invention, the nasal spray solution further comprises a propellant. The pH of the nasal spray solution is optionally between about pH 7 and 9, preferably 8.5 ± 0.5. Suitable buffers for use within these compositions are as described above or as otherwise known in the art. Other components may be added to enhance or maintain chemical stability, including preservatives, surfactants, dispersants, or gases. Suitable preservatives include, but are not limited to, phenol, methyl paraben, paraben, m-cresol, thiomersal, chlorobutanol, benzylalkonimum chloride, sodium benzoate, and the like. Suitable surfactants include, but are not limited to, oleic acid, sorbitan trioleate, polysorbates, lecithin, phosphotidyl cholines, and various long chain diglycerides and phospholipids. Suitable dispersants include, but are not limited to, ethylenediaminetetraacetic acid, and the like. Suitable gases include, but are not limited to, nitrogen, helium, chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs), hydrofluorocarbons (HFCs), carbon dioxide, air, and the like.
Within alternate embodiments, mucosal formulations are administered as dry powder formulations comprising the biologically active agent in a dry, usually lyophilized, form of an appropriate particle size, or within an appropriate particle size range, for intranasal delivery. Minimum particle size appropriate for deposition within the nasal or pulmonary passages is often about 0.5 μ mass median equivalent aerodynamic diameter (MMEAD), commonly about 1 μ MMEAD, and more typically about 2 μ MMEAD. Maximum particle size appropriate for deposition within the nasal passages is often about 10 μ MMEAD, commonly about 8 μ MMEAD, and more typically about 4 μ MMEAD. Intranasally respirable powders within these size ranges can be produced by a variety of conventional techniques, such as jet milling, spray drying, solvent precipitation, supercritical fluid condensation, and the like. These dry powders of appropriate MMEAD can be administered to a patient via a conventional dry powder inhaler (DPI), which rely on the patient's breath, upon pulmonary or nasal inhalation, to disperse the power into an aerosolized amount. Alternatively, the dry powder may be administered via air- assisted devices that use an external power source to disperse the powder into an aerosolized amount, e.g., a piston pump.
Dry powder devices typically require a powder mass in the range from about 1 mg to 20 mg to produce a single aerosolized dose ("puff). If the required or desired dose of the biologically active agent is lower than this amount, the powdered active agent will typically be combined with a pharmaceutical dry bulking powder to provide the required total powder mass. Preferred dry bulking powders include sucrose, lactose, dextrose, mannitol, glycine, trehalose, human serum albumin (HSA), and starch. Other suitable dry bulking powders include cellobiose, dextrans, maltotriose, pectin, sodium citrate, sodium ascorbate, and the like.
To formulate compositions for mucosal delivery within the present invention, the biologically active agent can be combined with various pharmaceutically acceptable additives, as well as a base or carrier for dispersion of the active agent(s). Desired additives include, but are not limited to, pH control agents, such as arginine, sodium hydroxide, glycine, hydrochloric acid, citric acid, acetic acid, etc. In addition, local anesthetics (e.g., benzyl alcohol), isotonizing agents (e.g., sodium chloride, mannitol, sorbitol), adsorption inhibitors (e.g., Tween 80), solubility enhancing agents (e.g., cyclodextrins and derivatives thereof), stabilizers (e.g., serum albumin), and reducing agents (e.g., glutathione) can be included. When the composition for mucosal delivery is a liquid, the tonicity of the formulation, as measured with reference to the tonicity of 0.9% (w/v) physiological saline solution taken as unity, is typically adjusted to a value at which no substantial, irreversible tissue damage will be induced in the nasal mucosa at the site of administration. Generally, the tonicity of the solution is adjusted to a value of about 1/3 to 3, more typically 1/2 to 2, and most often 3/4 to 1.7.
The biologically active agent may be dispersed in a base or vehicle, which may comprise a hydrophilic compound having a capacity to disperse the active agent and any desired additives. The base may be selected from a wide range of suitable carriers, including but not limited to, copolymers of polycarboxylic acids or salts thereof, carboxylic anhydrides (e.g., maleic anhydride) with other monomers (e.g., methyl (meth)acrylate, acrylic acid, etc.), hydrophilic vinyl polymers such as polyvinyl acetate, polyvinyl alcohol, polyvinylpyrrolidone, cellulose derivatives such as hydroxymethylcellulose, hydroxypropylcellulose, etc., and natural polymers such as chitosan, collagen, sodium alginate, gelatin, hyaluronic acid, and nontoxic metal salts thereof. Often, a biodegradable polymer is selected as a base or carrier, for example, polylactic acid, poly(lactic acid-glycolic acid) copolymer, polyhydroxybutyric acid, poly(hydroxybutyric acid-glycolic acid) copolymer and mixtures thereof. Alternatively or additionally, synthetic fatty acid esters such as polyglycerin fatty acid esters, sucrose fatty acid esters, etc. can be employed as carriers. Hydrophilic polymers and other carriers can be used alone or in combination, and enhanced structural integrity can be imparted to the carrier by partial crystallization, ionic bonding, crosslinking and the like. The carrier can be provided in a variety of forms, including, fluid or viscous solutions, gels, pastes, powders, microspheres and films for direct application to the nasal mucosa. The use of a selected carrier in this context may result in promotion of absorption of the biologically active agent. The biologically active agent can be combined with the base or carrier according to a variety of methods, and release of the active agent may be by diffusion, disintegration of the carrier, or associated formulation of water channels. In some circumstances, the active agent is dispersed in microcapsules (microspheres) or nanocapsules (nanospheres) prepared from a suitable polymer, e.g., isobutyl 2-cyanoacrylate and dispersed in a biocompatible dispersing medium applied to the nasal mucosa, which yields sustained delivery and biological activity over a protracted time.
To further enhance mucosal delivery of pharmaceutical agents within the invention, formulations comprising the active agent may also contain a hydrophilic low molecular weight compound as a base or excipient. Such hydrophilic low molecular weight compounds provide a passage medium through which a water-soluble active agent, such as a physiologically active peptide or protein, may diffuse through the base to the body surface where the active agent is absorbed. The hydrophilic low molecular weight compound optionally absorbs moisture from the mucosa or the administration atmosphere and dissolves the water-soluble active peptide. The molecular weight of the hydrophilic low molecular weight compound is generally not more than 10000 and preferably not more than 3000. Exemplary hydrophilic low molecular weight compound include polyol compounds, such as oligo-, di- and monosaccarides such as sucrose, mannitol, sorbitol, lactose, L-arabinose, D-erythrose, D-ribose, D-xylose, D-mannose, trehalose, D-galactose, lactulose, cellobiose, gentibiose, glycerin and polyethylene glycol. Other examples of hydrophilic low molecular weight compounds useful as carriers within the invention include N-methylpyrrolidone, and alcohols (e.g. oligovinyl alcohol, ethanol, ethylene glycol, propylene glycol, etc.) These hydrophilic low molecular weight compounds can be used alone or in combination with one another or with other active or inactive components of the intranasal formulation.
The compositions of the invention may alternatively contain as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers substances as required to approximate physiological conditions, such as pH adjusting and buffering agents, tonicity adjusting agents, wetting agents and the like, for example, sodium acetate, sodium lactate, sodium chloride, potassium chloride, calcium chloride, sorbitan monolaurate, triethanolamine oleate, etc. For solid compositions, conventional nontoxic pharmaceutically acceptable carriers can be used which include, for example, pharmaceutical grades of mannitol, lactose, starch, magnesium stearate, sodium saccharin, talcum, cellulose, glucose, sucrose, magnesium carbonate, and the like.
Therapeutic compositions for administering the biologically active agent can also be formulated as a solution, microemulsion, or other ordered structure suitable for high concentration of active ingredients. The carrier can be a solvent or dispersion medium containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (for example, glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof. Proper fluidity for solutions can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating such as lecithin, by the maintenance of a desired particle size in the case of dispersible formulations, and by the use of surfactants. In many cases, it will be desirable to include isotonic agents, for example, sugars, polyalcohols such as mannitol, sorbitol, or sodium chloride in the composition. Prolonged absorption of the biologically active agent can be brought about by including in the composition an agent which delays absorption, for example, monostearate salts and gelatin.
In certain embodiments of the invention, the biologically active agent is administered in a time-release formulation, for example in a composition which includes a slow release polymer. The active agent can be prepared with carriers that will protect against rapid release, for example a controlled release vehicle such as a polymer, microencapsulated delivery system or bioadhesive gel. Prolonged delivery of the active agent, in various compositions of the invention can be brought about by including in the composition agents that delay absorption, for example, aluminum monosterate hydrogels and gelatin. When controlled release formulations of the biologically active agent is desired, controlled release binders suitable for use in accordance with the invention include any biocompatible controlled-release material which is inert to the active agent and which is capable of incorporating the biologically active agent. Numerous such materials are known in the art. Useful controlled-release binders are materials that are metabolized slowly under physiological conditions following their intranasal delivery (e.g., at the nasal mucosal surface, or in the presence of bodily fluids following transmucosal delivery). Appropriate binders include but are not limited to biocompatible polymers and copolymers previously used in the art in sustained release formulations. Such biocompatible compounds are non-toxic and inert to surrounding tissues, and do not trigger significant adverse side effects such as nasal irritation, immune response, inflammation, or the like. They are metabolized into metabolic products that are also biocompatible and easily eliminated from the body.
Exemplary polymeric materials for use in this context include, but are not limited to, polymeric matrices derived from copolymeric and homopolymeric polyesters having hydrolysable ester linkages. A number of these are known in the art to be biodegradable and to lead to degradation products having no or low toxicity. Exemplary polymers include polyglycolic acids (PGA) and polylactic acids (PLA), poly(DL-lactic acid-co-glycolic acid)(DL PLGA), poly(D-lactic acid-coglycolic acid)(D PLGA) and poly(L-lactic acid-co-glycolic acid)(L PLGA). Other useful biodegradable or bioerodable polymers include but are not limited to such polymers as poly(epsilon-caprolactone), poly(epsilon-aprolactone-CO-lactic acid), poly(ε- aprolactone-CO-glycolic acid), poly(beta-hydroxy butyric acid), poly(alkyl-2-cyanoacrilate), hydrogels such as poly(hydroxyethyl methacrylate), polyamides, poly(amino acids) (i.e., L- leucine, glutamic acid, L-aspartic acid and the like), poly (ester urea), poly (2-hydroxyethyl DL- aspartamide), polyacetal polymers, polyorthoesters, polycarbonate, polymaleamides, polysaccharides and copolymers thereof. Many methods for preparing such formulations are generally known to those skilled in the art. Other useful formulations include controlled-release compositions e.g., microcapsules, U.S. Patent Nos. 4,652,441 and 4,917,893, lactic acid-glycolic acid copolymers useful in making microcapsules and other formulations, U.S. Patent Nos. 4,677,191 and 4,728,721, and sustained-release compositions for water-soluble peptides, U.S. Patent No. 4,675,189. Sterile solutions can be prepared by incorporating the active compound in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filtered sterilization. Generally, dispersions are prepared by incorporating the active compound into a sterile vehicle that contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above. In the case of sterile powders, methods of preparation include vacuum drying and freeze-drying which yields a powder of the active ingredient plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof. The prevention of the action of microorganisms can be accomplished by various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, sorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like. Mucosal administration according to the invention allows effective self-administration of treatment by patients, provided that sufficient safeguards are in place to control and monitor dosing and side effects. Mucosal administration also overcomes certain drawbacks of other administration forms, such as injections, that are painful and expose the patient to possible infections and may present drug bioavailability problems. For nasal and pulmonary delivery, systems for controlled aerosol dispensing of therapeutic liquids as a spray are well known. In one embodiment, metered doses of active agent are delivered by means of a specially constructed mechanical pump valve, U.S. Patent No. 4,511,069.
Dosage
For prophylactic and treatment purposes, the biologically active agent(s) disclosed herein may be administered to the subject in a single bolus delivery, via continuous delivery (e.g., continuous transdermal, mucosal, or intravenous delivery) over an extended time period, or in a repeated administration protocol (e.g., by an hourly, daily or weekly, repeated administration protocol). In this context, a therapeutically effective dosage of the glucose-regulating peptide may include repeated doses within a prolonged prophylaxis or treatment regimen that will yield clinically significant results to alleviate one or more symptoms or detectable conditions associated with a targeted disease or condition as set forth above. Determination of effective dosages in this context is typically based on animal model studies followed up by human clinical trials and is guided by determining effective dosages and administration protocols that significantly reduce the occurrence or severity of targeted disease symptoms or conditions in the subject. Suitable models in this regard include, for example, murine, rat, porcine, feline, non- human primate, and other accepted animal model subjects known in the art. Alternatively, effective dosages can be determined using in vitro models (e.g., immunologic and histopathologic assays). Using such models, only ordinary calculations and adjustments are typically required to determine an appropriate concentration and dose to administer a therapeutically effective amount of the biologically active agent(s) (e.g., amounts that are intranasally effective, transdermally effective, intravenously effective, or intramuscularly effective to elicit a desired response).
In an alternative embodiment, the invention provides compositions and methods for intranasal delivery of glucose-regulating peptide, wherein the glucose-regulating peptide compound(s) is/are repeatedly administered through an intranasal effective dosage regimen that involves multiple administrations of the glucose-regulating peptide to the subject during a daily or weekly schedule to maintain a therapeutically effective elevated and lowered pulsatile level of glucose-regulating peptide during an extended dosing period. The compositions and method provide glucose-regulating peptide compound(s) that are self-administered by the subject in a nasal formulation between one and six times daily to maintain a therapeutically effective elevated and lowered pulsatile level of glucose-regulating peptide during an 8-hour to 24-hour extended dosing period.
Kits The instant invention also includes kits, packages and multicontainer units containing the above described pharmaceutical compositions, active ingredients, and/or means for administering the same for use in the prevention and treatment of diseases and other conditions in mammalian subjects. Briefly, these kits include a container or formulation that contains one or more glucose-regulating peptide proteins, analogs or mimetics, and/or other biologically active agents in combination with mucosal delivery enhancing agents disclosed herein formulated in a pharmaceutical preparation for mucosal delivery.
The intranasal formulations of the present invention can be administered using any spray bottle or syringe, or by instillation. An example of a nasal spray bottle is the, "Nasal Spray Pump w/ Safety Clip, Pfeiffer SAP #60548, which delivers a dose of 0.1 mL per squirt and has a diptube length of 36.05 mm. It can be purchased from Pfeiffer of America of Princeton, NJ.
Aerosol Nasal Administration of a Glucose-regulating Peptide
We have discovered that the GRPs can be administered intranasally using a nasal spray or aerosol. This is surprising because many proteins and peptides have been shown to be sheared or denatured due to the mechanical forces generated by the actuator in producing the spray or aerosol. In this area the following definitions are useful. 1. Aerosol - A product that is packaged under pressure and contains therapeutically active ingredients that are released upon activation of an appropriate valve system.
2. Metered aerosol - A pressurized dosage form comprised of metered dose valves, which allow for the delivery of a uniform quantity of spray upon each activation. 3. Powder aerosol - A product that is packaged under pressure and contains therapeutically active ingredients in the form of a powder, which are released upon activation of an appropriate valve system.
4. Spray aerosol - An aerosol product that utilizes a compressed gas as the propellant to provide the force necessary to expel the product as a wet spray; it generally applicable to solutions of medicinal agents in aqueous solvents.
5. Spray - A liquid minutely divided as by a jet of air or steam. Nasal spray drug products contain therapeutically active ingredients dissolved or suspended in solutions or mixtures of excipients in nonpressurized dispensers.
6. Metered spray - A non-pressurized dosage form consisting of valves that allow the dispensing of a specified quantity of spray upon each activation.
7. Suspension spray - A liquid preparation containing solid particles dispersed in a liquid vehicle and in the form of course droplets or as finely divided solids.
The fluid dynamic characterization of the aerosol spray emitted by metered nasal spray pumps as a drug delivery device ("DDD"). Spray characterization is an integral part of the regulatory submissions necessary for Food and Drug Administration ("FDA") approval of research and development, quality assurance and stability testing procedures for new and existing nasal spray pumps.
Thorough characterization of the spray's geometry has been found to be the best indicator of the overall performance of nasal spray pumps. In particular, measurements of the spray's divergence angle (plume geometry) as it exits the device; the spray's cross-sectional elliptichy, uniformity and particle/droplet distribution (spray pattern); and the time evolution of the developing spray have been found to be the most representative performance quantities in the characterization of a nasal spray pump. During quality assurance and stability testing, plume geometry and spray pattern measurements are key identifiers for verifying consistency and conformity with the approved data criteria for the nasal spray pumps.
Definitions
Plume Height - the measurement from the actuator tip to the point at which the plume angle becomes non-linear because of the breakdown of linear flow. Based on a visual examination of digital images, and to establish a measurement point for width that is consistent with the farthest measurement point of spray pattern, a height of 30 mm is defined for this study
Major Axis - the largest chord that can be drawn within the fitted spray pattern that crosses the COMw in base units (mm)
Minor Axis - the smallest chord that can be drawn within the fitted spray pattern that crosses the COMw in base units (mm)
Ellipticity Ratio - the ratio of the major axis to the minor axis, preferably between 1.0 and 1.5, and most preferably between 1.0 and 1.3.
D1O - the diameter of droplet for which 10% of the total liquid volume of sample consists of droplets of a smaller diameter (μm) D50 - the diameter of droplet for which 50% of the total liquid volume of sample consists of droplets of a smaller diameter (μm), also known as the mass median diameter
Dg0 - the diameter of droplet for which 90% of the total liquid volume of sample consists of droplets of a smaller diameter (μm)
Span - measurement of the width of the distribution, the smaller the value, the narrower the distribution. Span is calculated as: — — . v D50
% RSD - percent relative standard deviation, the standard deviation divided by the mean of the series and multiplied by 100, also known as % CV.
Volume- the volume of liquid or powder discharged from the delivery device with each actuation, preferably between 0.01 mL and about 2.5 mL and most preferably between 0.02 mL and 0.25 mL.
EXAMPLES
The above disclosure generally describes the present invention, which is further exemplified by the following examples. These examples are described solely for purposes of illustration, and are not intended to limit the scope of the invention. Although specific terms and values have been employed herein, such terms and values will likewise be understood as exemplary and non-limiting to the scope of the invention.
EXAMPLE 1
Materials and Equipment Used
The present example illustrates the reagents, equipment, and the source of each used in the subsequent Examples 1 and 2 of the instant application.
Table 1 illustrates the sample reagents used in the subsequent Examples 1 and 2. Table 1: Sample Reagents
Figure imgf000065_0001
Table 2 illustrates the source and components of the MatTek EpiAirway™ System that is described in greater detail in Example 2 of the instant application.
Table 2: In Vitro Epithelial Cell Model System Components
Figure imgf000066_0001
Table 3 illustrates the source and components of the LDH assay system described in greater details in Example 2 of the instant application.
Table 3: LDH (Cytotoxicity) and MTT (Cell Viability) Assay Components
Figure imgf000066_0002
Table 4 illustrates the instruments and other related laboratory supplies and source of each used herein.
Table 4: Instruments and Other Related Supplies
Figure imgf000067_0001
EXAMPLE 2
In vitro Screening of Liraglutide Formulations
Two rounds of in vitro screening were performed using formulations of liraglutide (Arg34Lys26-(N-ε-(γ-Glu(N-α-hexadecanoyl)))-GLP-l(7-37)), structure shown below:
COOH
Theoretical MW: 3751 Da
Figure imgf000068_0001
For the first round of in vitro screening a variety of enhancers were tested at low (1), middle (2), and high (3) concentrations including:
• Enhancer A = Polysorbate 20 (Tween 20) • Enhancer B = Polysorbate 80 (Tween 80)
• Enhancer C = disodium EDTA
• Enhancer D = Methyl-beta-cyclodextrin (Me-β-CD)
• Enhancer E = Didecanoylphosphatidyl choline (DDPC)
In the first round of in vitro screening, the formulations shown in Table 5 were manufactured and tested. Several formulations were manufactured and evaluated. The concentration of liraglutide was held constant at 5 mg/mL to allow screening of a large number of formulations with various potential enhancers with a minimal amount of API. All formulations tested contain 8 mM phosphate as a buffer to achieve a formulation pH of 8.0 ± 0.3. NaCl was added to each formulation as needed to achieve an osmolality of approximately 220 mOsm/kg H2O. The formulations were also evaluated for short-term stability at 25°C/60% RH for 15 days. Change in appearance, Liraglutide content and purity were monitored.
A total volume of 0.4 mL was manufactured for each formulation in a 1.5 mL amber eppendorf tubes and tested (n = 3) on MatTek cell cultures (24 well format). 50 μL of each sample was applied to the apical side of the cell culture inserts. Each cell culture insert was incubated in 0.5 mL basolaterol media with 0.05 % Tween 20 for 1 hr at 370C, 100 rpm in 12-well plates. Tween 20 was added to the media to prevent liraglutide from absorbing to surfaces at low concentrations. TER was recorded before and after the incubation period. LDH assay was performed from apical as well as basolaterol samples. MTT assay was performed on cell culture inserts after TER and LDH samples were taken. % permeation was assessed by two methods, ELISA and HPLC. Basolaterol media samples were divided into five aliquots and stored in 1.5 amber eppendorf tubes. The aliquot needed for LDH assay was stored 2-8°C. The other four aliquots for ELISA and HPLC analysis were stored at - 20 0C until analysis was performed.
For each formulation, pH, appearance, and osmolality were noted at T = 0. HPLC analysis was performed for content on the stock of liraglutide created for manufacturing of the formulations. Remaining amounts of each formulation were transferred into non-silanized amber Type 1 vials and placed at 25 °C/60 % RH. After 7 days at 25 °C/60 % RH storage, formulations were tested for content and purity using HPLC. Appearance of all formulations was noted at T = 7 day as well. Formulations were frozen at -200C until analysis. The formulations in Table 5 were tested.
Table 5: Formulations Tested In First Round if In Vitro Screening
Figure imgf000069_0001
Abbreviations: M-β-CD=methyl-beta-cyclodextrin, EDTA=disodium edetate, DDPC=L-α-ρhosphatidylcholine didecanoyl, BAK=Benzalkonium chloride, MTT=MTT assay; LDH=LDH assay, TER=transepithelial electrical resistance
The formulations were tested using the in vitro EpiAirway Model System for the transepithelial resistance assay (TER), cell viability assay (MTT), lactate dehydrogenase cell death assay (LDH), and tissue permeation assay. The results were used to determine which formulation achieved the greatest degree of tissue permeation and TER reduction while resulting in no significant cell toxicity. The stability of the formulations was also assayed for pH, appearance, and osmolality changes; peptide content; and peptide purity.
In Vitro Model Triplicate samples of each formulation and controls were evaluated using the EpiAirway
System in vitro model tracheal/ bronchial epithelial cell membrane inserts by MatTek Corp.
(Ashland, MA), catalog # Air-100.
The epithelial cells were grown on porous membrane-bottomed cell culture inserts at an air-liquid interface, which results in differentiation of the cells to a highly polarized morphology. The apical surface is ciliated with a microvillous ultrastructure and the epithelium produces mucus (the presence of mucin was confirmed by immunoblotting). The inserts had a diameter of 0.875 cm, providing a surface area of 0.6 cm2. The cells were plated onto the inserts at the factory approximately three weeks before shipping.
EpiAirway culture membranes were received the day before the experiment started. They were shipped in phenol red and hydrocortisone free medium. Each cell culture insert was placed in a well of a 12 well plate containing 0.5 mL of serum free media (which was warmed to 37°C). The membranes were cultured at 37°C for 24 hrs to allow tissues to equilibrate. The cell culture inserts were refeed with fresh media twice a day until the study began.
Transepithelial Electrical Resistance (TER)
TER measurements were read using a Tissue Resistance Measurement Chamber connected to an Epithelial Voltohmeter with the electrode leads, both from World Precision Instruments. Background TER was read for each insert on the day the experiment began. After TER was read, 0.5 mL fresh media with 0.05 % Tween was placed in the bottom of each well in a 12-well plate. Inserts were drained on paper towel and placed into the new wells with fresh media, keeping the inserts numbered to correlate with background TER measurements. 50 ul of formulation was added to each insert. Inserts were placed in a shaking incubator at 100 rpm and 37°C for 1 hr.
The electrodes and a tissue culture blank insert were equilibrated for at least 20 min in fresh media with the power off prior to checking calibration. The background resistance was measured with 1.5 mL media in the Endohm tissue chamber and 300 ul media in a blank Millicell-CM insert. The top electrode was adjusted so that it was submerged in the media but not making contact with the top surface of the insert membrane. Background resistance of the blank insert was 5-20 ohms. For each TER determination, 300 ul media was added to the insert followed by a 20 min incubation at RT before placement in the Endohm chamber to read TER. Resistance was expressed as (resistance measured - blank) x 0.6 cm2. All TER values were reported as a function of the surface area of the tissue. TER was calculated as:
TER= (Ri -Rb) xA
Where Ri is resistance of the insert with a membrane, Rb is the resistance of the blank insert, and A is the area of the membrane (0.6 cm2). The TER values are expressed in %TER, i.e., relative to a control value obtained with PBS in the absence of permeation enhancers or peptide
(control = approximately 1000 ohms-cm2; normalized to 100). A decrease in TER value relative to the control indicates a decrease in cell membrane resistance and an increase in mucosal epithelial cell permeability to ions. Lactate Dehydrogenase (LDHD Assay
The amount of cyctotoxicity was assayed by measuring the release of LDH from the cells using a CytoTox 96 Cytotoxicity Assay Kit, from Promega Corp. LDH was measured from both apical as well as basolaterol side of inserts. All samples were assayed at the same time. Duplicate samples were performed for the apical and basolaterol samples collected form each cell culture insert in the study. For the basolaterol samples, 50 μl was loaded, in duplicate, on a 96 well plate. Fresh, cell-free media with 0.05% Tween 20 was used as a blank for all basolaterol samples. Apical samples were centrifuged at 10,000 rpm for 5 min to allow cell debris to settle to the bottle of the tube. 2 μL of the supernatant was removed and added to a 96 well plate. 48 μL of media (without Tween 20) was used to dilute the supernatant 1:25. Fresh, cell-free media (without Tween 20) was used as a blank for the all apical samples. 50 μl substrate solution, (12 mL Assay Buffer added to a fresh bottle of Substrate Mix, made according to the kit), was added to each well and the plates were incubated for 30 min at RT in the dark. Following incubation, 50 μl of stop solution was added to each well and the plates were read on a Molecular Devices optical density plate reader at 490 nm using Soft Maxpro. LDH units were calculated as follows for each sample: LDH unit = (OD490 nm - appropriate blank) *Dilution factor (DF). Each cell culture's apical and basolaterol LDH units were added to each other and compared to the LDH control to calculate the % LDH.
MTT Assay
Cell viability was assessed using the MTT assay kit, cat # MTT-100 by MatTek Corp. This kit measures the uptake and transformation of tetrazolium salt to its formazan dye (MTT).
MTT concentrate was thawed and diluted with media at a ratio of 2 mL MTT: 8 mL media. 300 μl MTT-media mix was added to each well in a fresh 24-well plate. Tissue culture inserts were gently drained on paper towel and transferred to the MTT containing well, while avoiding trapping bubbles underneath the inserts, and then incubated at 37°C in the dark for a minimum of 3 hours.
After incubation, each insert was removed from the plate, blotted gently (the bottom of the insert on a paper towel) and then immersed in wells of a fresh 24-well plate, each containing 1 mL extractant solution. The plate was then be covered and placed on shaker for 1 hr. After the 1 hr period, the liquid in each insert was decanted back into the well from which it was taken, and the insert was discarded. 50 μl of the extractant solution from each well was pipetted in triplicate into a 96 well plate and diluted with the addition of 150 μl of fresh extractant solution. Extract blanks were included in triplicate. The optical density of the samples was measured at 550 nm on a Molecular Devices optical density plate reader using Soft Maxpro). The MTT values are expressed in %MTT, i.e., relative to a control value obtained with
PBS in the absence of permeation enhancers or peptide
Permeation
ELISA was used to quantitate the amount of liraglutide that permeated across the apical to the basolateral side of the insert. The loading volume was 100 μL per insert and the permeation sampling time was
60 minutes. Each formulation, as well as controls, were tested using n= 3 inserts. Controls for this study included MatTek basal media and 9% Triton X -100. Each tissue insert was placed in an individual well containing 0.95 mL of MatTek basal media. On the apical surface of the inserts, 100 μL of test formulation was applied according to study design, and the samples were placed on a shaker (~100 rpm) for 1 h at 37°C. At the end of the incubation period, 50 uL of ~20,000 KIUnits of aprotnin was added to each underlying culture media samples and stored at 2-8° C for ELISA analysis. The amount of liraglutide which permeated into the basolateral side was divided by the amount of liraglutide applied to the apical side to yield the % permeation
First Round Results The TER, MTT, and permeation results for the first round in vitro testing are summarized in Table 6. Most of the enhancers resulted in low % TER and high % MTT. Formulations containing C (EDTA), D (M-β-CD), and E (DDPC) either individually or in combination increased permeation of liraglutide to greater than 10% (samples #38, #40, #42, and #46).
Table 6: Summary of First Round In Vitro Data
Figure imgf000073_0001
Figure imgf000074_0001
The control (PBS) for the First Round experiment showed no reduction of TER after the one-hour incubation period at 370C. Enhancer A and B showed little to no reduction in TER as well, indicating that these excipients did not affect the tight junction (TJ) in the presence of liraglutide. Enhancer C, disodium EDTA (EDTA), showed significant TER reduction. The lowest concentration of EDTA tested, 1 mg/mL, showed 80% TER reduction whereas 10 and 25 mg/mL (mid and high cone.) resulted in 100% reduction in TER. Enhancer D, methyl-beta- cyclodextrin (M-β-CD), at 45 mg/mL (Dl) showed some effect in reducing TER. Enhancer E, DDPC (L-α-phosphatidylcholine didecanoyl), was not tested by itself because of its low CMC and low aqueous solubility. Formulation containing 90 mg/mL Me-β-CD (D2) and 1 mg/mL DDPC (El) reduced TER in half. Formulation containing all low concentration of EDTA (Cl, 1 mg/mL), Me-β-CD (Dl, 45 mg/mL) and DDPC (El, 1 mg/mL) resulted in a large but not complete reduction in TER reduction similar to mid-to-high concentrations of EDTA. The formulations that completely reduced TER after a one-hour incubation period were those that contained at least 10 mg/mL EDTA.
Most of the formulations tested ranged around 100 ± 20 % MTT, indicating very little if any effect on the cell viability. Formulation containing 10 mg/mL EDTA (C2) and 90 mg/mL Me-β-CD (D2) reduced the cell viability by 30%.
The permeation of liraglutide was calculated for each cell culture insert. Control formulation (no enhancers) and formulations containing enhancers A or B did not result in liraglutide permeating across the cell layer. Formulations containing 1 mg/mL EDTA (Cl) showed no liraglutide permeation. Low to no permeation of liraglutide were also obtained with formulations containing 45 mg/mL Me-β-CD (Dl) or 45 mg/mL M-β-CD/1 mg/mL DDPC (Dl/El) combination. Formulations containing higher amounts of EDTA, 10 or 25 mg/mL, showed improved permeation of 4-8% depending on the concentration of EDTA. The highest amount of permeation was achieved with a formulation that contained both C2 and D2 (10 mg/mL EDTA and 90 mg/mL M-β-CD).
Physical and chemical stability results following 15 days storage at 250C for the formulations tested in the first round in vitro study Formulations were stored at 25°C/60% RH for 15 days. All formulations at T=O were clear and colorless solutions and the measured pH was pH 8.0 ± 0.3. Cell culture inserts were tested for each formulation (N=3). The results are shown in Table 7. Table 7: First Round Formulation Stability at 25°C/65% RH Results
Figure imgf000076_0001
All formulations tested remained physically stable, clear and colorless solutions after 15-day storage at 25°C. Recovery of liraglutide ranged from 92% to 101%, most likely due to the variability of the HPLC content assay and small sample amount used for HPLC sample preparation. A 1-2% decrease in peptide purity was noted for these formulations after 15-day storage at 25°C.
First Round Summary
Liraglutide in PBS alone showed no permeatility in vitro. TER was unchanged after 1 hour incubation period. Addition of Tween 20 or 80 did not enhance permeation or decrease % TER at the concentrations tested in this study (0-1%). The addition of EDTA increased % permeation and decreased % TER. There was a trend that as the concentration of EDTA increased the % permeation of liraglutide also increased. Liraglutide in the presence of 25 mg/mL ETDA resulted in 8.3 ± 2.4 % permeation. Permeation improved when in combinations of EDTA and Me-β-CD, or EDTA, Me-β-CD and DDPC. All tested formulations remained clear and colorless and showed high protein recovery after 15 days storage at 250C, indicating good 15 day stability at room temperature.
Second Round Formulations
The second in vitro screening study focused on three enhancers: EDTA, Me-β-CD, and DPPC. The second screening round tested formulations containing the three permeation enhancers at various levels individually or in combination. In addition, formulation stability at the liraglutide concentration of 5 mg/mL in the presence of permeation enhancers was evaluated. Preservatives were also investigated for effects on % permeation, % TER, % MTT, % LDH, and stability. All formulations tested contained 5 mg/mL liraglutide and 8 mM phosphate, pH 8.0. The basolateral media contained 1% BSA to prevent adsorption. Formulations were stored at 370C for 7 days and analyzed for peptide recovery.
Optimization of permeation enhancers utilized the Design of Experiments (DOE) approach by Stat-Ease statistical software, Design-Expert. EDTA was tested at three different concentrations of 10, 15, and 20 mg/mL. Me-β-CD was tested at two different concentrations of 22.5 and 45 mg/mL and DDPC was tested at two different concentrations of 0.5 and 1 mg/mL. The concentration of liraglutide was held constant at 5 mg/mL and 8 mM phosphate buffer was added to each formulation to achieve a target pH of 8.0 ± 0.3. A tonicifier was not added to any of the formulations unless specified. In the second round of in vitro screening, the formulations shown in Table 8 were manufactured and tested.
Table 8: Formulations Tested in Second Round of In Vitro Screening
Figure imgf000077_0001
Figure imgf000078_0001
Abbreviations: M-β-CD=methyl-beta-cyclodextrin, EDTA=disodium edetate, DDPC=L-α-phosphatidylcholiπe didecanoyl, BAK=benzalkonium chloride, CB=Chorobutanol, MP=sodium methyl paraben, PP= sodium propyl paraben, EtOH=Ethanol, MTT=MTT assay; LDH=LDH assay, TER=transepithelial electrical resistance
Second Round Results
The % TER, % MTT, and % permeation results for the second round in vitro screening are summarized in Table 9. Statistical analysis showed that Enhancer C (EDTA) was the best performing factor in the TER assay (p=0.0001). A moderate decrease in % MTT was observed when enhancer E (DDPC) was at high concentrations. Statistical analysis showed that Enhancers C (p=0.0001) and E (p=0.0001) were the best performing factors in the MTT assay (C and E, p=0.0209). A mild to moderate increase in % LDH was observed when enhancer C (EDTA) was present. Statistical analysis showed that Enhancers C (EDTA) and D (M-β-CD) were the best performing factors in the LDH assay (p=0.0418). High permeation was observed in the presence of enhancer C (EDTA). The addition of enhancers D (M-β-CD) and E (DDPC) resulted in a synergistic effect on permeation. Statistical analysis showed that enhancers C (p=0.0001) and D (p=€.05) were the best performing factors in the permeation assays. Table 9: Summary of Second Round In Vitro Screening Data
Figure imgf000079_0001
Figure imgf000080_0001
Formulations containing EDTA and Me-β-CD enhancers resulted in high % MTT, low % LDH, and enhanced permeation of peptide. The results showed that permeation was improved from 0 to ~20% with a formulation containing one or more of the following excipients: EDTA, Me-β-CD and DDPC (samples #18, #22, #26, #27). A surface response 3D plot showing the effect of EDTA and Me-β-CD is shown in Figure 1.
The results suggest that EDTA was a dominate factor for increasing liraglutide permeation (p = 0.0001) and Me-β-CD was also considered as an important factor with a p value of 0.0539. The p value was calculated to be 0.1411 for the effect of DDPC on liraglutide permeation. Results of the DOE analysis show that optimal permeation can be achieved at 10-15 mg/mL EDTA and 45 mg/mL M-β-CD. Previous clinical studies using EDTA and Me-β-CD indicated that both enhancers are well tolerated for intranasal administration.
Content and purity of liraglutide was measured using EGPLC at T = 0 and after 1 week storage at 37°C. The initial appearance, osmolality, and pH were recorded immediately after formulations were manufactured. All formulations were initially clear and colorless with pH between 8.1 and 8.3. HPLC analysis was also performed on samples initially to assess the liraglutide content and purity. Initial purity of liraglutide was approximately 98% and content for each formulation ranged form 4.9 to 5.3 mg/mL.
The physical stability (appearance) was recorded after 1 week storage at 37°C. The HPLC results reflect low recovery for 20 mg/mL EDTA and 45 mg/mL Me-β-CD (#20, # 24, and #28) formulations, see second round stability results in Table 10. Recovery of peptide for most of the other formulations was 100 ± 5% and peptide purity dropped only 1-4% after 1 week at 37°C (see Table 10), except for formulations containing 0.5 % CB. All formulations were clear and colorless except for formulations containing 20 mg/mL EDTA and 45 mg/mL Me-β- CD (#20, # 24, and #28), see Table 11. At T =7 days at 37°C, gel (fibril) formation was observed in formulations containing high amounts of enhancer C (EDTA) and various levels of enhancer D (M-β-CD). Chemical instability was much greater for formulations #31 and #39 than other formulations. Table 10: Second Round Stability Results
Figure imgf000081_0001
Figure imgf000082_0001
Table 11: Formulation Appearance After 1-Wk and 15-Days Storage at 370C
Figure imgf000082_0002
At day 7, gel-like precipitants were visible in formulations containing both 20 mg/mL EDTA and 45 mg/mL M-β-CD. Formulations containing only either 20 mg/mL EDTA or 45 mg/mL Me-β-CD showed no change in appearance. Combination of the two enhancers at high concentrations likely promotes physically instability of liraglutide formulations. At day 15, more formulations showed physical instability, including formulations that contain 45 mg/mL Me-β-CD in the presence of greater than 10 mg/mL EDTA, or 22.5 mg/mL Me-β-CD in the presence of 25 mg/mL EDTA.
EXAMPLE 3
Physical Stability of Liraglutide Formulations in the Presence of Phosphate Buffer
Two additional liraglutide formulations tested,are shown in Table 12.
Table 12: Phosphate Containing Liraglutide Formulations
Figure imgf000083_0001
The two formulations in phosphate buffer were tested for physical stability after 14 days at 370C. The results are shown in Table 13.
Table 13: Stability of Liraglutide Formulations in Phosphate Buffer
Figure imgf000083_0002
The results show that the EDTA/ M-β-CD liraglutide formulation is less stable in phosphate buffer after 2 weeks at 37°C. However, the liraglutide formulation containing EDTA was physically stable in phosphate buffer. Phosphate buffer was determined not to be the preferred buffer for an EDTA/ M-β-CD liraglutide formulation. EXAMPLE 4
Physical Stability of Liraglutide Formulations
A study was performed to evaluate the physical stability of intranasal formulations with high concentrations of liraglutide in the presence of selected permeation enhancers and stabilizers. One of the objectives of the study was to identify excipients that could stabilize the liraglutide formulation after physical instability was observed with liraglutide formulations at 5 mg/mL screening concentration in the presence of permeation enhancers. The study focused on improving the stability of 50 mg/mL Liraglutide formulation containing 10 mg/mL EDTA and 45 mg/mL Me-β-CD as the permeation enhancers. The stability of liraglutide in the presence of different ratios of EDTA to Me-β-CD was also investigated. A variety of potential stabilizers such as sugars, polymers, amino acids, lipids, and surfactants were evaluated (see Table 14). Phosphate buffer was not added to any of the formulations. The formulation pH was increased from 8.0 to 8.5-8.7 by addition of NaOH. Physical stability was measured at 37°C. The compositions of formulations that were evaluated are listed in Table 14. The physical stability of the formulations was monitored by visual inspection of the solutions at the time of manufacturing and after 2-wk storage at 37°C.
Table 14: Compositions of Formulations Under Evaluations
Figure imgf000084_0001
Figure imgf000085_0001
Abbreviations: BAK=Benzalkonium chloride, HMPC= hydroxypropyl methylcellulose, EtOH=ethanol, PEG= Poly(ethylene glycol) All the formulations were prepared by adding the listed amount of each ingredient from stock solutions or powders as specified in Table 15. The formulations were mixed by gentle inversion. Initial testing included pH, osmolality and appearance followed by storage at 37°C accelerated temperature. The chemicals used are listed in Table 15.
Table 15: List of Chemicals
Figure imgf000086_0001
Physical Stability Results
The physical characteristics of the formulations are shown in Table 16. All formulations were clear and colorless solutions at the time of manufacturing. The initial measured pH values were within 0.3 unit of pH 8.5. Appearance of the formulations was determined after 2 week storage at 37°C. Table 16: Formulation Appearance After 14 days
Figure imgf000087_0001
Figure imgf000088_0001
WGPS = white, gel-like precipitants, string-like WGPB = white, gel-like precipiants, at the bottom of vial
Results of the physical stability study show that formulations at both tested concentrations of liraglutide (25 and 50 mg/mL) were stably stored at 37°C for 2 weeks. AU concentrations tested of EDTA/Me-β-CD (10/22.5 mg/mL, 5/45 mg/mL, and 10/45 mg/mL) generated physically stable (clear and colorless) formulations. Formulation #1 (liraglutide only) without additional excipients was physically stable. No physical instability was observed with EDTA only formulations with tested stabilizers after 14 days at 37°C. EDTA/Me-β-CD formulations at various concentrations without phosphate present or any additional stabilizers were clear and colorless after 2 weeks at 37°C (#10, #11, #12, #36, #37, and #38). Additional stabilizers added to the EDTA/Me-β-CD formulations that remained clear and colorless included the following: 75 mM arg (#2, #9, #13, #39), 75 mM leu (#3. #17, #43), 75 mM ser (#4, #41), 0.5% gel (#5, #29, #55), 75 mM val (#42), 75 mM mannitol (#7), 75 mM glutamic acid (#14, #40), 1.0% HPMC (#30, #56), 0.5% Pluronic F68 (#31, #57), and 1% glycerol (#23, #49). The addition of more than one additional stabilizer also resulted in clear and colorless solutions after 2 weeks at 37°C for the following formulations: 75mM arg and 0.5% gel (#6), 1 mg/mL DDPC and 1% EtOH (#8), and 25/25/25 mM arg/ser/leu (#18, #44). After 14 days at 37°C, EDTA/Me- β-CD formulations without phosphate remained physically stable with and without additional stabilizers. The results obtained after 25 days at 370C are shown in Table 17.
Table 17: Formulation Appearance After 25 Days at 370C
Figure imgf000089_0001
Figure imgf000090_0001
The results show that a majority of the EDTA formulations still remained physically stable. EDTA/Me-β-CD (10/45 mg/mL) precipitated after ~3 wks at 37°C whereas the same formulation, but with a lower EDTA concentration (5 mg/mL), remained clear and colorless. Formulation #15 and #24 was also successful in maintaining physical stability. Similar results were seen in formulations containing 25 mg/mL liraglutide.
At 14 days, only clear and colorless formulations were assayed for peptide content and purity. The results are shown in the following Table 18.
Table 18: HPLC Measurement of Peptide Purity
Figure imgf000090_0002
Figure imgf000091_0001
Manufactured a day later than all other formulations. - Not tested The results showed a minimum change in content for all formulations assayed. A small reduction in peptide purity -0.5-2.5 % was observed.
The stability study at 50 mg/mL liraglutide concentration showed that gelatin or leucine can function as the stabilizer for the liraglutide formulation containing 10 mg/mL EDTA and 45 mg/mL Me-β-CD (in the absence of phosphate buffer). EXAMPLE 5
In vitro Permeation of Liraglutide Formulations (Third Round Study) The factors evaluated in the third round of the in vitro screening included 1) effect of liraglutide concentration (5 vs. 50 mg/mL); 2) α-CD as an additional permeation enhancer; 3) effect of leucine; and 4) effect of reduced EDTA concentration (5 mg/mL). The formulations tested in the Third Round Study are shown in Table 19.
Table 19: Third Round Study Formulations
Figure imgf000092_0001
All formulations tested had high cell viability and low cytotoxicity based on the data collected form the MTT and LDH assay. Table 20 shows the permeation data collected for 50 mg/mL liraglutide formulations containing EDTA as the permeation enhancer. Average permeation for these formulations was 10-15%. The permeation data for the remaining formulations are also shown in Table 20. All of the formulations showed ~10-25% permeation. The results showed that M-β-CD subtantially improved permeation in combination with EDTA and DDPC.
Table 20: Permeation Data for Third Round Study
Figure imgf000093_0001
EXAMPLE 6
Stability of Liraglutide Formulations
Two sets of permeation enhancer(s) were selected for additional evaluation based on the previous experiments. One contained 10 mg/mL EDTA and 45 mg/ml Me-β-CD combination and the other contained 10 mg/mL EDTA. The liraglutide formulations (See Table 19) were evaluated for stability upon addition of stabilizers, alpha-cyclodextrin, or change in pH. Liraglutide was added at concentrations of 5 or 50 mg/mL.
The formulations were placed on real time (5 0C) and accelerated stability (25 0C and 37 0C) and tested on the in vitro cell model. Each formulation was manufactured at two liraglutide concentrations of 5 and 50 mg/mL to study the effect of liraglutide concentration on the in vitro permeation. The formulation containing mannitol as the only excipient was the control for the in vitro experiment. The main permeation enhancers for the liraglutide formulations are 10 mg/mL EDTA alone or 10 mg/mL EDTA/45 mg/mL Me-β-CD combination.
Two batches were manufactured for each formulation at each liraglutide concentration to study the batch-to-batch variability on formulation physical stability. The factors evaluated in the third round for the formulation stability are 1) batch-to-batch variability, 2) DDPC as an additional stabilizer, 3) effect of phosphate buffer, 4) effect of formulation pH (7.7 and 8.0 vs. 8.5), and 5) effect of reduced EDTA concentration (5 mg/mL).
At the initial time point, all formulations were clear and colorless and within ±9% of target for liraglutide Content (Table 21). Purity of liraglutide was 97-98% for all the formulations and the formulation pH was ± 0.2 of target as shown in Table 21.
Table 21: Initial Analysis of in vitro Screening Formulations
Figure imgf000094_0001
Figure imgf000095_0001
Table 22 shows the appearance for the formulations containing 50 mg/mL liraglutide with 10 mg/mL EDTA as the permeation enhancer after 14 and 21 days of storage at 37 0C. All formulations remained physically stable. Table 23 summarizes the appearance of all 50 mg/mL liraglutide formulations with EDTA/cyclodextrin as the permeation enhancers after 14 and 21 days of storage at 37 0C. Three formulations remained physical stable at pH 8.5 up to 21-day storage at 37 0C. The enhancer/stabilizer combinations were 1) 10 mg/ mL EDTA and 32 mg/mL α-CD; 2) 10 mg/ mL EDTA, 45 mg/mL Me-β-CD and 1 mg/mL DDPC; or 3) 10 mg/ mL EDTA, 45 mg/mL M-β-CD, 1 mg/mL DDPC and 75 mM leucine. DDPC acted as a stabilizer for liraglutide formulations. Unexpected physically instability was noted for the formulation containing 50 mg/mL liraglutide, 10 mg/ml EDTA, 45 mg/mL Me-β-CD and 75 mM leucine. In the second screening round, this formulation remained clear and colorless after 25 days at 37 0C. After reviewing and comparing the two rounds, the major difference found was the initial formulation pH. The formulation batch from round 2 had a pH of 8.7 vs. pH 8.5 for the round 3 batch. Liraglutide formulation stability at 50 mg/mL was highly dependent of pH as demonstrated by formulation containing 10 mg/ mL EDTA, 45 mg/mL M-β-CD, 1 mg/mL DDPC and 75 mM leucine at pH 7.7-8.5 (batch #55-64 in Table 23).
Table 22: Stability After 14 and 21 Days at 370C
Figure imgf000096_0001
Table 23: Physical Stability After 14 and 21 Days of Storage at 37°C
Figure imgf000097_0001
The results show that the physical stability of the formulation is pH dependant. The results showed that formulations containing mannitol control (pH 8.5); EDTA alone (pH 8.5); EDTA/DDPC (pH 8.5); EDTA and leucine (pH 8.5); EDTA/DDPC and leucine (pH 8.5); EDTA/Me-β-CD (pH 8.0); EDTA and alpha-cyclodetrin (pH 8.5); EDTA/Me-β-CD/DDPC (pH 8.5); EDTA/Me-β-CD/DDPC and leucine (pH 8.5) were clear and colorless formulations after 21 days at 370C.
The effects if changing pH on the physical stability of a liraglutide formulation containing EDTA, Me-β-CD, and leucine was further evaluated. The results shown in Table 24 further show the effect of pH on liraglutide formulation physical stability. Increasing the pH to greater than 8.5 resulted in improved stability of the EDTA/Me-β-CD and leucine formulation.
Table 24: Physical Stability after 21 Days at 370C
Figure imgf000098_0001
EXAMPLE 7
Physical Stability of Liraglutide Formulations after 29 Days of Storage Several formulations of Table 19 were further monitored for changes in appearance as well as in purity and content of liraglutide. Tables 25 and 26 summarize the appearance of these formulations after storage at 5, 25, and 37°C. All formulations remained clear and colorless at 5 and 25°C up to 29 days. All formulations remained physically stable after 29 days at 37°C expect for EDTA, M-β-CD, DDPC and leucine formulation, which contained small white gel-like precipitants at day 29 (Table 27 and 28).
The physical stability of 5 and 50 mg/mL liraglutide formulations was tested after 29 days of storage at 5, 25 and 370C. The results of these stability studies are shown in Tables 25, 26, 27, and 28. Table 25: Physical Stability of 5 mg/mL Liraglutide after 29 Days of Storage at 5 and 250C
Figure imgf000099_0001
CC= Clear and Colorless
Table 26: Physical Stability of 50 mg/mL Liraglutide after 29 Days of Storage at 5 and 250C
Figure imgf000100_0001
CC= Clear and Colorless
All of the formulations tested and shown in Table 25 and 26 were physically stable after 9 days storage at 5 and 250C.
Table 27: Physical Stability of 5 mg/mL Liraglutide after 29 Days of Storage at 370C
Figure imgf000100_0002
Table 28: Physical Stability of 50 mg/mL Liraglutide after 29 Days of Storage at 370C
Figure imgf000101_0001
The formulations shown in Tables 27 and 28 were physically stable after 29 days storage at 370C. The one exception was the 50 mg/mL liraglutide, EDTA/Me-β-CD/DDPC/Leu formulation which resulted in small amounts of liraglutide precipitating out of solution. The other formulations shown were clear and colorless.
EXAMPLE 8
Chemical Stability of Liraglutide Formulations after 29 Day Storage The chemical stability of 5 and 50 mg/mL liraglutide formulations was tested after
29 days of storage at 5 and 370C and after 14 days at 250C. HPLC analysis was performed at various timepoints to assess the content and purity of liraglutide in these formulations after storage. All tested formulations remained chemically stable after 29 days at 5°C as illustrated in Table 29. After 14 days at 25 0C, purity was determined to be 96-97% for all formulations and some loss of recovery for some formulations were noted (<5 %) as shown in Table 30. Purity of liraglutide is reduced by approximately 4-8% and the recovery of liraglutide remained very high > 92 % even after 29 days at 37°C (Table 31). The results of these stability studies are shown in Tables 29, 30 and 31. Table 29: Physical Stability of 5 and 50 mg/mL Liraglutide After 29 Days of Storage at 50C
Figure imgf000102_0001
Table 30: Physical Stability of 5 and 50 mg/mL Liraglutide After 14 Days of Storage at 250C
Figure imgf000102_0002
Table 31: Physical Stability of 5 and 50 mg/mL Liraglutide after 29 Days of Storage at 370C
Figure imgf000103_0001
The results of the chemical stability studies showed that all formulations tested in Table 29 at 5 and 50 mg/mL liraglutide were stable, no loss of liraglutide recovery or purity, after 29 days storage at 50C. High liraglutide recovery (-95-100%) and zero to minimal (~0-2%) reduction in liraglutide purity was shown in Table 30 after 14 days storage at 250C. Most formulations in Table 31 had high liraglutide recovery after 29 days storage at 370C. The 50 mg/mL EDTA/Me-β-CD/DDPC/Leu formulation contained small amounts of precipitants, but the liraglutide recovery was high. All 50 mg/mL liraglutide formulations had a purity reduction of about 4-6%.
1O2 EXAMPLE 9
Pharmacokinetics Study in Rabbits
An initial Pharmacokinetic (PK) study in rabbits was conducted. The intranasal formulations tested are shown in Table 32.
Table 32: Rabbit PK Study 1 : Tested Intranasal Liraglutide Formulations
Figure imgf000104_0001
The PK results from Rabbit PK study 1 are shown in Figure 2. The PK results showed that formulations 4, 5, and 7 had increased bioavailablity compared to the formulation without enhancers (Fl). Two additional Rabbit PK studies were conducted. The formulations containing liraglutide were tested in Rabbit PK Study 2 and 3 (See Table 33).
Table 33: Rabbit PK Study 2 and 3: Tested Intranasal Liraglutide Formulations
Figure imgf000105_0001
The dose response for nasal liraglutide formulations is shown in Figure 3. The results of Rabbit PK Study 2 are showed some degree of dose proportionality. Rabbit PK Study 3 evaluated the effect of increasing enhancer concentrations based on
20 mg/mL liraglutide formulations. The results of this study are shown in Figure 4. The Rabbit Study 3 data is compared to 20 mg/mL (10, 45, 1) data from Rabbit PK Study 2. The results showed enhanced PK with increased M-β-CD (90 mg/mL). The highest bioavailablity was shown with the Study 3-2 formulation (10, 90, 5). The PK profiles of liraglutide show a surprising departure from that obtained with intranasal native GLP-I in that the elevated plasma levels are prolonged with the derivative molecule. The basis for the prolonged PK profile was investigated. "Pulse chase" experiments were also conducted where rabbits were treated with formulation Study 2-5 followed at (0 and 15) or (0 and 30) minutes with excipients only (no liraglutide). The results showed slightly higher plasma levels, suggesting that application of excipients alone after the initial dose of liraglutide futher increased its bioavailability (See Figure 5).
EXAMPLE 10
Calculation of Intranasal Dosage for Liraglutide
Dosing of liraglutide for intranasal administration was calculated relative to a subcutaneous (SQ) dosage. Studies with liraglutide showed that administering 1.25 to 1.9 mg SQ daily increased beta cell secretion of insulin in patients with Type 2 diabetes (www.diabetesincontrol.covι/modules.php?name=News&file=article&sid=3839; www.medpagetoday.com/Pediatrics/Obesity/tb/3535). A bioavailability after SQ administration of approximately 55% results in a systemic dose of approximately 700 μg. The results suggest that approximately 50 mg/ml liraglutide may provide an effective single systemic dose for humans. An equivalent nasal administration for 1.25 to 1.9 mg per day SQ, based on intranasal bioavailability of liraglutide (see Example 9), is a 1.25 to 1.9 mg administration. Obviously, high concentrations are needed to deliver this amount of peptide in a 100 microliter spray. Using a 50 mg/mL concentration of intranasal liraglutide, likely two to four sprays per day, is required for therapeutic benefit comparable to SQ.
Although the foregoing invention has been described in detail by way of example for purposes of clarity of understanding, it is apparent to the artisan that certain changes and modifications are comprehended by the disclosure and may be practiced without undue experimentation within the scope of the appended claims, which are presented by way of illustration, not limitation.

Claims

WHAT IS CLAIMED IS:
L An aqueous pharmaceutical formulation for intranasal delivery of liraglutide, comprising liraglutide, a solubilizing agent, and a chelating agent.
2. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 1, wherein liraglutide is present at less than about 100 mg/mL.
3. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 1, wherein liraglutide is present at less than about 60 mg/mL.
4. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 1, wherein liraglutide is present at less than about 25 mg/mL.
5. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 1, wherein the solubilizing agent is selected from the group consisting of a eyelodextrin, hydroxypropyl-β-cyclodcxtrin, sulfobutylether-β-cyclodextrin, and methyl-β-cyclodextrin.
6. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 5, wherein the solubilizing agent is methyl-β-cyclodextrin.
7. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 6, wherein methyl-β-cyclodextrin is present at less than about 100 mg/mL in the formulation.
8. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 6, wherein methyl-β-cyclodextrin is present at less than about 60 mg/mL in the formulation.
9. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 6, wherein methyl-β-cyclodextrin is present at less than about 25 mg/mL in the formulation.
10. The formulation of Claim 1, wherein the chelating agent is ethylene diamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA) or ethylene glycol tetraacetic acid (EGTA).
11. The formulation of Claim 10, wherein the chelating agent is EDTA.
12. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 11, wherein EDTA is present at less than about 50 mg/mL in the formulation.
13. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 11, wherein EDTA is present at less than about 20 mg/mL in the formulation.
14. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 11, wherein EDTA is present at less than about 15 mg/mL in the formulation.
15. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 1, further comprising leucine.
16. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 1 , further comprising a surface active agent selected from the group consisting of nonionic polyoxyethylene ether, bile salts such, sodium glycocholate, deoxycholate, derivatives of fusidic acid, sodium taurodihydrofusidate, L-α-phosphatidylcholine didecanoyl (DDPC), polysorbate 80, polysorbate 20, a polyethylene glycol, cetyl alcohol, polyvinylpyrolidone, a polyvinyl alcohol, lanolin alcohol, and sorbitan monooleate.
17. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 16, wherein the surface active agent is DDPC.
18. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 1, wherein the pH is about 9.0 or less.
19. The pharmaceutical formulation of Claim 18, wherein the pH is about 8.5 ± 0.3.
20. An aqueous pharmaceutical formulation for intranasal delivery of liraglutide, comprising liraglutide, methyl-β-cyclodextrin, and EDTA.
21. A use of liraglutide in the manufacture of a medicament for treating a metabolic syndrome in a mammal, comprising administering intranasally a therapeutically effective amount of a liraglutide formulation to the mammal wherein the medicament comprises liraglutide, a solubilizing agent, and a chelating agent.
22. The use of Claim 21, wherein the metabolic syndrome is selected from the group consisting of Type 2 diabetes, Type 1 diabetes, impaired glucose tolerance, hyperglycemia, metabolic syndrome (syndrome X and/or insulin resistance syndrome), glucosuria, metabolic acidosis, arthritis, cataracts, diabetic neuropathy, diabetic nephropathy, diabetic retinopathy, diabetic cardiomyopathy, obesity, conditions exacerbated by obesity, hypertension, hyperlipidemia, atherosclerosis, osteoporosis, osteopenia, frailty, bone loss, bone fracture, acute coronary syndrome, short stature due to growth hormone deficiency, infertility due to polycystic ovary syndrome, anxiety, depression, insomnia, chronic fatigue, epilepsy, eating disorders, chronic pain, alcohol addiction, diseases associated with intestinal motility, ulcers, irritable bowel syndrome, inflammatory bowel syndrome; short bowel syndrome; and the prevention of disease progression in Type 2 diabetes.
23. The use of Claim 21 , wherein the solubilizing agent is selected from the group consisting of cyclodextrin, hydroxypropyl-β-cyclodextrin, sulfobutylether-β-cyclodextrin, and methyl-β-cyclodextrin.
24. The use of Claim 23, wherein the solubilizing agent is methyl-β-cyclodextrin.
25. The use of Claim 21, wherein the chelating agent is ethylene diamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA) or ethylene glycol tetraacetic acid (EGTA).
26. The use of Claim 25, wherein the chelating agent is EDTA.
27. The use of Claim 21, wherein the formulation has a pH of about 7.5 to about 9.0.
28. The use of Claim 21 , wherein a dose containing about 0.1 mg/mL to about 2 mg/mL of a liraglutide is administered to the mammal.
29. The use of Claim 21, wherein a dose containing about 0.4 mg/mL to about 0.6 mg/mL of liraglutide is administered to the mammal.
30. The use of Claim 21 , wherein the mammal is a human.
31. A use of liraglutide in the manufacture of a medicament for treating a metabolic syndrome in a mammal comprising administering intranasally a therapeutically effective amount of a liraglutide formulation to the mammal, wherein the medicament comprises liraglutide and one or more excipients selected from the group consisting of a solubilizing agent and a chelating agent.
32. The use of Claim 31, wherein the chelating agent is ethylene diamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA) or ethylene glycol tetraacetic acid (EGTA).
33. The us e of Claim 31 , wherein the chelating agent is EDTA.
34. The use of Claim 31 , wherein the solubilizing agent is selected from the group consisting of a cyclodextrin, hydroxypropyl-β-cyclodextrin, sulfobutylether-β-cyclodextrin, and methyl-β-cyclodextrin.
35. The use of Claim 31, wherein the solubilizing agent is methyl-β-cyclodextrin.
36. A dosage form of liraglutide, comprising an aqueous pharmaceutical formulation of liraglutide, a solubilizing agent, and a chelating agent having a pH of greater than 7.5, wherein the formulation comprises a therapeutically effective amount of liraglutide.
37. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the pH is about 9.0 or less.
38. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the pH is about 8.5 or less.
39. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the pH is about 8.0 or less.
40. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the concentration of liraglutide is at least about 20 mg/ml.
41. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the concentration of liraglutide is at least about 50 mg/ml.
42. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the concentration of liraglutide is at least about 75 mg/ml.
43. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein said dosage form is suitable for intra-nasal administration to achieve a dose of from about 0.1 mg/mL to about 2 mg/mL of said liraglutide.
44. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein said dosage form is suitable for intra-nasal administration to achieve a dose of from about 0.4 mg/mL to about 0.6 mg/mL of said liraglutide.
45. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein said dosage form is suitable for multiple intra-nasal administrations per day.
46. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the methyl-β-cyclodextrin is present at least about 20 mg/mL in the formulation.
47. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the methyl-β-cyclodextrin is present at least about 45 mg/mL in the formulation.
48. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the methyl-β-cyclodextrin is present at least about 90 mg/mL in the formulation.
49. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the EDTA is present at least about 5 mg/mL in the formulation.
50. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the EDTA is present at least about 10 mg/mL in the formulation.
51. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, wherein the EDTA is present at least about 15 mg/mL in the formulation
52. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, further comprising a preservative.
53. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 52, wherein the preservative is chlorobutanol.
54. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, further comprising leucine.
55. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 36, further comprising a surface active agent selected from the group consisting of nonionic polyoxyethylene ether, bile salts such, sodium glycocholate, deoxycholate, derivatives of fusidic acid, sodium taurodihydrofusidate, L-α-phosphatidylcholine didecanoyl (DDPC), polysorbate 80, polysorbate 20, a polyethylene glycol, cetyl alcohol, polyvinylpyrolidone, a polyvinyl alcohol, lanolin alcohol, and sorbitan monooleate.
56. The liraglutide dosage form of Claim 55, wherein the surface active agent is DDPC.
57. A use of liraglutide in the manufacture of a medicament for treating metabolic syndromes in a mammal, wherein the medicament comprises a therapeutically effective amount of liraglutide and one or more excipients selected from the group consisting of a solubilizing agent, a chelating agent, and one or more polyols.
58. The use of a liraglutide formulation of Claim 57, wherein the formulation further comprises a surface active agent.
59. The use of a liraglutide formulation of Claim 58, wherein the surface active agent is selected from the group consisting of nonionic polyoxyethylene ether, bile salts such, sodium glycocholate, deoxycholate, derivatives of fusidic acid, sodium taurodihydrofusidate, L-α-phosphatidylcholine didecanoyl (DDPC), polysorbate 80, polysorbate 20, a polyethylene
no glycol, cetyl alcohol, polyvinylpyrolidone, a polyvinyl alcohol, lanolin alcohol, and sorbitan monooleate.
60. The use of a liraglutide formulation of Claim 59, wherein the surface active agent is DDPC.
61. The use of a liraglutide formulation of Claim 57, wherein one or more polyols are selected from the group consisting of sucrose, mannitol, sorbitol, lactose, L-arabinose, D-erythrose, D-ribose, D-xylose, D-mannose, trehalose, D-galactose, lactulose, cellobiose, gentibiose, glycerin and glycol.
62. The use of a liraglutide formulation of Claim 61, wherein the polyol is sorbitol.
63. The use of a liraglutide formulation of Claim 57, wherein the chelating agent is ethylene diamine tetraacetic acid (EDTA) or ethylene glycol tetraacetic acid (EGTA).
64. The use of a liraglutide formulation of Claim 63, wherein the chelating agent is EDTA.
65. The use of a liraglutide formulation of Claim 57, wherein the solubilizing agent is selected from the group consisting of a cyclodextrin, hydroxypropyl-β-cyclodextrin, sulfobutylether-β-cyclodextrin, and methyl-β-cyclodextrin.
66. The use of a liraglutide formulation of Claim 65, wherein the solubilizing agent is a methyl-β-cyclodextrin.
Ill
PCT/US2007/060517 2006-06-07 2007-01-12 Pharmaceutical formulations of glp-1 derivatives WO2007146448A1 (en)

Applications Claiming Priority (8)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US80416506P 2006-06-07 2006-06-07
US60/804,165 2006-06-07
US80623006P 2006-06-29 2006-06-29
US60/806,230 2006-06-29
US80705506P 2006-07-11 2006-07-11
US60/807,055 2006-07-11
US82509006P 2006-09-08 2006-09-08
US60/825,090 2006-09-08

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2007146448A1 true WO2007146448A1 (en) 2007-12-21

Family

ID=38521280

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2007/060517 WO2007146448A1 (en) 2006-06-07 2007-01-12 Pharmaceutical formulations of glp-1 derivatives

Country Status (1)

Country Link
WO (1) WO2007146448A1 (en)

Cited By (11)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2011064316A2 (en) 2009-11-25 2011-06-03 Paolo Botti Mucosal delivery of peptides
WO2011162989A3 (en) * 2010-06-24 2012-03-08 Vanderbilt University Glp-1 receptor modulation of addiction, neuropsychiatric disorders and erectile dysfunction
EP2526971A1 (en) 2011-05-25 2012-11-28 ArisGen SA Mucosal delivery of drugs
WO2013037267A1 (en) * 2011-09-14 2013-03-21 深圳翰宇药业股份有限公司 Variant of liraglutide and conjugate thereof
WO2013083826A3 (en) * 2011-12-09 2013-08-01 Novo Nordisk A/S Glp-1 agonists
WO2016066818A1 (en) * 2014-10-31 2016-05-06 Gubra Aps Compositions and peptides having dual glp-1r and glp-2r agonist activity
CN108066281A (en) * 2017-12-30 2018-05-25 陕西慧康生物科技有限责任公司 Treat the Liraglutide nasal drop of type-2 diabetes mellitus
WO2020127476A1 (en) 2018-12-19 2020-06-25 Krka, D.D., Novo Mesto Pharmaceutical composition comprising glp-1 analogue
CN111888334A (en) * 2020-06-28 2020-11-06 苏州天微肽生物医药科技有限公司 Liraglutide microsphere sustained-release agent and preparation method and application thereof
WO2021123228A1 (en) 2019-12-18 2021-06-24 Krka, D.D., Novo Mesto Pharmaceutical composition comprising glp-1 analogue
CN114452258A (en) * 2022-03-09 2022-05-10 成都大学 Liraglutide liposome preparation and preparation method and application thereof

Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2005065714A1 (en) * 2003-12-26 2005-07-21 Nastech Pharmaceutical Company Inc. Intranasal administration of glucose-regulating peptides
WO2006025882A2 (en) * 2004-08-25 2006-03-09 The Uab Research Foundation Absorption enhancers for drug administration
US20060074025A1 (en) * 2003-12-26 2006-04-06 Nastech Pharmaceutical Company Inc. Therapeutic formulations for transmucosal administration that increase glucagon-like peptide-1 bioavailability

Patent Citations (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2005065714A1 (en) * 2003-12-26 2005-07-21 Nastech Pharmaceutical Company Inc. Intranasal administration of glucose-regulating peptides
US20060074025A1 (en) * 2003-12-26 2006-04-06 Nastech Pharmaceutical Company Inc. Therapeutic formulations for transmucosal administration that increase glucagon-like peptide-1 bioavailability
WO2006025882A2 (en) * 2004-08-25 2006-03-09 The Uab Research Foundation Absorption enhancers for drug administration

Cited By (13)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2011064316A2 (en) 2009-11-25 2011-06-03 Paolo Botti Mucosal delivery of peptides
WO2011162989A3 (en) * 2010-06-24 2012-03-08 Vanderbilt University Glp-1 receptor modulation of addiction, neuropsychiatric disorders and erectile dysfunction
EP2526971A1 (en) 2011-05-25 2012-11-28 ArisGen SA Mucosal delivery of drugs
WO2013037267A1 (en) * 2011-09-14 2013-03-21 深圳翰宇药业股份有限公司 Variant of liraglutide and conjugate thereof
WO2013083826A3 (en) * 2011-12-09 2013-08-01 Novo Nordisk A/S Glp-1 agonists
CN104244981A (en) * 2011-12-09 2014-12-24 诺和诺德A/S Glp-1 agonists
WO2016066818A1 (en) * 2014-10-31 2016-05-06 Gubra Aps Compositions and peptides having dual glp-1r and glp-2r agonist activity
CN108066281A (en) * 2017-12-30 2018-05-25 陕西慧康生物科技有限责任公司 Treat the Liraglutide nasal drop of type-2 diabetes mellitus
WO2020127476A1 (en) 2018-12-19 2020-06-25 Krka, D.D., Novo Mesto Pharmaceutical composition comprising glp-1 analogue
WO2021123228A1 (en) 2019-12-18 2021-06-24 Krka, D.D., Novo Mesto Pharmaceutical composition comprising glp-1 analogue
CN111888334A (en) * 2020-06-28 2020-11-06 苏州天微肽生物医药科技有限公司 Liraglutide microsphere sustained-release agent and preparation method and application thereof
CN111888334B (en) * 2020-06-28 2022-03-18 苏州天微肽生物医药科技有限公司 Liraglutide microsphere sustained-release agent and preparation method and application thereof
CN114452258A (en) * 2022-03-09 2022-05-10 成都大学 Liraglutide liposome preparation and preparation method and application thereof

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
EP1951198B1 (en) Intranasal administration of rapid acting insulin
EP1696960B1 (en) Intranasal administration of glucose-regulating peptides
US20080318861A1 (en) Mucosal Delivery of Stabilized Formulations of Exendin
US20080318837A1 (en) Pharmaceutical Formation For Increased Epithelial Permeability of Glucose-Regulating Peptide
US20060210614A1 (en) Method of treatment of a metabolic disease using intranasal administration of exendin peptide
US9993425B2 (en) Compositions for intranasal delivery of human insulin and uses thereof
US20060074025A1 (en) Therapeutic formulations for transmucosal administration that increase glucagon-like peptide-1 bioavailability
WO2007065156A2 (en) Pharmaceutical formulation for increased epithelial permeability of glucose-regulating peptide
WO2007146448A1 (en) Pharmaceutical formulations of glp-1 derivatives
WO2007061434A2 (en) A pharmaceutical formulation of glp-1 and its use for treating a metabolic syndrome
US20060127320A1 (en) Method of delivering parathyroid hormone to a human
US20060069021A1 (en) Compositions and methods for intranasal administration of inactive analogs of PTH or inactivated preparations of PTH or PTH analogs
CN101340893A (en) Intranasal administration of rapid-acting insulin
US20070185035A1 (en) Enhanced mucosal administration of neuroprotective peptides
US20070213270A1 (en) Peptide yy formulations having increased stability and resistance to microbial agents
US20070232537A1 (en) Intranasal pyy formulations with improved transmucosal pharmacokinetics
MX2008004980A (en) Intranasal administration of rapid acting insulin

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 07756360

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

122 Ep: pct application non-entry in european phase

Ref document number: 07756360

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1